Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf32-ppc.c revision 1.12
      1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
      2    Copyright (C) 1994-2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      3    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
      4 
      5    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6 
      7    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10    (at your option) any later version.
     11 
     12    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16 
     17    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18    along with this program; if not, write to the
     19    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
     20    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21 
     22 /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
     23    when they appear unused.  The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
     24    needs them.  */
     25 #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
     26 
     27 #include "sysdep.h"
     28 #include <stdarg.h>
     29 #include "bfd.h"
     30 #include "bfdlink.h"
     31 #include "libbfd.h"
     32 #include "elf-bfd.h"
     33 #include "elf/ppc.h"
     34 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
     35 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
     36 #include "dwarf2.h"
     37 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
     38 
     39 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1.  */
     40 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
     41 
     42 typedef enum split16_format_type
     43 {
     44   split16a_type = 0,
     45   split16d_type
     46 }
     47 split16_format_type;
     48 
     49 /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
     50 
     51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
     52   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     53 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
     54   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     55 
     56 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
     57 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
     58 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
     59 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
     60 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
     61 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
     62 
     63 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
     64    section.  */
     65 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
     66 
     67 /* For old-style PLT.  */
     68 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
     69 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
     70 
     71 /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
     72 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
     73 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
     74   ((4*4									\
     75     + (h != NULL							\
     76        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
     77        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
     78     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
     79    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
     80 
     81 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
     82 
     83 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
     84 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
     85 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
     86     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     87   {
     88     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
     89     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
     90     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
     91     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
     92     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
     93     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
     94     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     95     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     96   };
     97 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
     98     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     99   {
    100     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
    101     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
    102     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
    103     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
    104     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
    105     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
    106     0x60000000, /* nop */
    107     0x60000000, /* nop */
    108   };
    109 
    110 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
    111 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
    112 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
    113     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    114   {
    115     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
    116     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
    117     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
    118     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
    119     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
    120     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
    121     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    122     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    123   };
    124 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
    125     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    126   {
    127     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
    128     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
    129     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
    130     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
    131     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    132     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    133     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    134     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    135   };
    136 
    137 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
    138    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
    139 
    140 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
    141 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
    142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
    143 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
    144 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
    145    a shared library. */
    146 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
    147 
    148 /* Some instructions.  */
    149 #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
    150 #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
    151 #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
    152 #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
    153 #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
    154 #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
    155 #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
    156 #define B		0x48000000
    157 #define BA		0x48000002
    158 #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
    159 #define BCTR		0x4e800420
    160 #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
    161 #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
    162 #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
    163 #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
    164 #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
    165 #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
    166 #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
    167 #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
    168 #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
    169 #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
    170 #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
    171 #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
    172 #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
    173 #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
    174 #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
    175 #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
    176 #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
    177 #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
    178 #define NOP		0x60000000
    179 #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
    180 
    181 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
    182 #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
    183 #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
    184 
    185 /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
    186 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
    187   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
    188    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
    189    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
    190 
    191 /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
    193 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
    194    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
    195    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
    196    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
    197    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
    198    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
    199    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
    200 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
    201 	    complain, special_func)				\
    202   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
    203 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
    204 	 #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
    205 
    206 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
    207 
    208 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
    209   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
    210   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    211        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    212 
    213   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
    214   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    215        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    216 
    217   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    218      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    219   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
    220        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    221 
    222   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
    223   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
    224        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    225 
    226   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
    227   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    228        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    229 
    230   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
    231   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    232        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    233 
    234   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
    235      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    236   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    237        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    238 
    239   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    240      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    241   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    242        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    243 
    244   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    245      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
    246      bits must be zero.  */
    247   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    248        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    249 
    250   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    251      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
    252      two bits must be zero.  */
    253   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    254        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    255 
    256   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    257   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    258        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    259 
    260   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    261   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    262        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    263 
    264   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    265      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
    266      zero.  */
    267   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    268        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    269 
    270   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    271      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
    272      be zero.  */
    273   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    274        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    275 
    276   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
    277      symbol.  */
    278   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    279        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    280 
    281   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    282      the symbol.  */
    283   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    284        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    285 
    286   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    287      the symbol.  */
    288   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    289        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    290 
    291   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    292      the symbol.  */
    293   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    294        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    295 
    296   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
    297      entry for the symbol.  */
    298   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    299        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    300 
    301   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
    302      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
    303      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
    304      shared library into the object, because the object being
    305      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
    306   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    307        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    308 
    309   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
    310      entries.  */
    311   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    312        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    313 
    314   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
    315   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    316        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    317 
    318   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
    319      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
    320      addend.  */
    321   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    322        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    323 
    324   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
    325      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
    326      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
    327   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    328        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    329 
    330   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
    331   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    332        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    333 
    334   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
    335   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
    336        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    337 
    338   /* 32-bit PC relative */
    339   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
    340        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    341 
    342   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    343      FIXME: not supported.  */
    344   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    345        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    346 
    347   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    348      FIXME: not supported.  */
    349   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
    350        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    351 
    352   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    353      the symbol.  */
    354   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    355        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    356 
    357   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    358      the symbol.  */
    359   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    360        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    361 
    362   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    363      the symbol.  */
    364   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    365        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    366 
    367   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
    368      small data items.  */
    369   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    370        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    371 
    372   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
    373   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    374        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    375 
    376   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
    377   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    378        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    379 
    380   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
    381   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    382        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    383 
    384   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
    385   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    386        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    387 
    388   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
    389   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    390        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    391 
    392   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    393        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    394 
    395   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    396        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    397 
    398   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
    399   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    400        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    401 
    402   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    403        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    404 
    405   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
    406      definition of its TLS sym.  */
    407   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    408        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    409 
    410   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
    411      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
    412      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
    413   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    414        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    415 
    416   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
    417   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    418        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    419 
    420   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    421   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    422        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    423 
    424   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    425   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    426        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    427 
    428   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    429   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    430        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    431 
    432   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
    433      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
    434   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    435        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    436 
    437   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
    438   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    439        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    440 
    441   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    442   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    443        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    444 
    445   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    446   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    447        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    448 
    449   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    450   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    451        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    452 
    453   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    454      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
    455      to the first entry.  */
    456   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    457        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    458 
    459   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
    460   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    461        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    462 
    463   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    464   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    465        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    466 
    467   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    468   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    469        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    470 
    471   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    472      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
    473      first entry.  */
    474   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    475        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    476 
    477   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
    478   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    479        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    480 
    481   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    482   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    483        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    484 
    485   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    486   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    487        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    488 
    489   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
    490      the offset to the entry.  */
    491   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    492        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    493 
    494   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    495   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    496        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    497 
    498   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    499   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    500        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    501 
    502   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    503   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    504        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    505 
    506   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
    507      offset to the entry.  */
    508   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    509        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    510 
    511   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    512   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    513        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    514 
    515   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    516   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    517        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    518 
    519   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    520   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    521        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    522 
    523   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
    524      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
    525 
    526   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    527   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    528        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    529 
    530   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    531   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    532        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    533 
    534   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    535   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    536        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    537 
    538   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
    539   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    540        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    541 
    542   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
    543      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
    544      is negative.  */
    545   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    546        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    547 
    548   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    549      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
    550      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    551   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    552        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    553 
    554   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    555      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
    556      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    557   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    558        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    559 
    560   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
    561      small data items.	 */
    562   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    563        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    564 
    565   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
    566      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
    567      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    568   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    569        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    570 
    571   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
    572   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
    573   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
    574   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
    575   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
    576   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
    577 
    578   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
    579      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
    580      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    581   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    582        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    583 
    584   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
    585   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
    586        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    587 
    588   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
    589   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
    590        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    591 
    592   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
    593   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
    594        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    595 
    596   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
    597   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
    598        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    599 
    600   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
    601   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
    602        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    603 
    604   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
    605   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    606        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    607 
    608   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
    609   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    610        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    611 
    612   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
    613   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    614        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    615 
    616   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
    617   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    618        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    619 
    620   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
    621      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
    622      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
    623   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    624        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    625 
    626   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
    627   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    628        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    629 
    630   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    631   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
    632        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    633 
    634   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    635   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
    636        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    637 
    638   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    639   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    640        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    641 
    642   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    643   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    644        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    645 
    646   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
    647   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    648        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    649 
    650   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
    651   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    652        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    653 
    654   /* e_li split20 format.  */
    655   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
    656        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    657 
    658   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    659        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    660 
    661   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
    662   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
    663        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    664 
    665   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
    666   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
    667        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    668 
    669   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
    670   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
    671        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    672 
    673   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
    674      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    675   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
    676        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    677 
    678   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
    679   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
    680        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    681 
    682   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
    683   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
    684        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    685 
    686   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
    687   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    688        NULL),
    689 
    690   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
    691   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    692        NULL),
    693 
    694   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
    695   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    696        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    697 };
    698 
    699 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
    701 
    702 static void
    703 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
    704 {
    705   unsigned int i, type;
    706 
    707   for (i = 0;
    708        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    709        i++)
    710     {
    711       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
    712       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
    713 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
    714 	abort ();
    715       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    716     }
    717 }
    718 
    719 static reloc_howto_type *
    720 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    721 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
    722 {
    723   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
    724 
    725   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    726   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    727     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    728 
    729   switch (code)
    730     {
    731     default:
    732       return NULL;
    733 
    734     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
    735     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    736     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
    737     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
    738     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
    739     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
    740     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
    741     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
    742     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
    743     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
    744     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    745     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    746     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
    747     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
    748     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    749     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    750     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
    751     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
    752     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
    753     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
    754     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
    755     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
    756     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
    757     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
    758     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
    759     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
    760     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
    761     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
    762     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
    763     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
    764     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
    765     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
    766     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
    767     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
    768     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
    769     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
    770     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
    771     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
    772     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
    773     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
    774     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    775     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
    776     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
    777     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
    778     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
    779     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
    780     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
    781     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
    782     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
    783     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
    784     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
    785     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
    786     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
    787     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
    788     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
    789     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
    790     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
    791     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
    792     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
    793     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
    794     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
    795     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
    796     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
    797     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
    798     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
    799     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
    800     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
    801     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
    802     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
    803     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
    804     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
    805     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
    806     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
    807     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
    808     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
    809     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
    810     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
    811     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
    812     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
    813     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
    814     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
    815     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
    816     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
    817     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
    818     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
    819     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
    820     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
    821     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
    822     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
    823     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
    824     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
    825     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
    826     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
    827     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
    828     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
    829     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
    830     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
    831     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
    832     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
    833     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
    834     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
    835     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
    836     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
    837     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
    838     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
    839       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
    840       break;
    841     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
    842       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
    843       break;
    844     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
    845       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
    846       break;
    847     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
    848       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
    849       break;
    850     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
    851       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
    852       break;
    853     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
    854       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
    855       break;
    856     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
    857     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
    858     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
    859     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
    860     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
    861     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
    862     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
    863     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
    864     }
    865 
    866   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
    867 };
    868 
    869 static reloc_howto_type *
    870 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    871 			   const char *r_name)
    872 {
    873   unsigned int i;
    874 
    875   for (i = 0;
    876        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    877        i++)
    878     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
    879 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
    880       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    881 
    882   return NULL;
    883 }
    884 
    885 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
    886 
    887 static bool
    888 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
    889 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
    890 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
    891 {
    892   unsigned int r_type;
    893 
    894   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    895   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    896     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    897 
    898   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
    899   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
    900     {
    901       /* xgettext:c-format */
    902       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    903 			  abfd, r_type);
    904       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    905       return false;
    906     }
    907 
    908   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
    909 
    910   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
    911      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
    912   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
    913     {
    914       /* xgettext:c-format */
    915       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    916 			  abfd, r_type);
    917       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    918 
    919       return false;
    920     }
    921 
    922   return true;
    923 }
    924 
    925 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
    926 
    927 static bfd_reloc_status_type
    928 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    929 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    930 			 asymbol *symbol,
    931 			 void *data,
    932 			 asection *input_section,
    933 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    934 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
    935 {
    936   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
    937   long insn;
    938   bfd_size_type octets;
    939   bfd_vma value;
    940 
    941   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    942     {
    943       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
    944       return bfd_reloc_ok;
    945     }
    946 
    947   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
    948   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
    949   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
    950     return bfd_reloc_continue;
    951 
    952   value = 0;
    953   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
    954     value = symbol->value;
    955   value += (reloc_entry->addend
    956 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
    957 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
    958   value -= (reloc_entry->address
    959 	    + input_section->output_offset
    960 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
    961   value >>= 16;
    962 
    963   octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
    964   if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
    965 				  input_section, octets))
    966     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
    967 
    968   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    969   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
    970   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
    971   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    972   return bfd_reloc_ok;
    973 }
    974 
    975 static bfd_reloc_status_type
    976 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    977 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    978 			 asymbol *symbol,
    979 			 void *data,
    980 			 asection *input_section,
    981 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    982 			 char **error_message)
    983 {
    984   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
    985      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
    986      link time.  */
    987   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    988     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
    989 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
    990 
    991   if (error_message != NULL)
    992     *error_message = bfd_asprintf (_("generic linker can't handle %s"),
    993 				     reloc_entry->howto->name);
    994   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
    995 }
    996 
    997 /* Sections created by the linker.  */
    999 
   1000 typedef struct elf_linker_section
   1001 {
   1002   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
   1003   asection *section;
   1004   /* Section name.  */
   1005   const char *name;
   1006   /* Associated bss section name.  */
   1007   const char *bss_name;
   1008   /* Associated symbol name.  */
   1009   const char *sym_name;
   1010   /* Associated symbol.  */
   1011   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
   1012 } elf_linker_section_t;
   1013 
   1014 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
   1015    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
   1016    based on different addend's.  */
   1017 
   1018 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
   1019 {
   1020   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
   1021   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
   1022   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
   1023   bfd_vma offset;
   1024   /* addend used */
   1025   bfd_vma addend;
   1026   /* which linker section this is */
   1027   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
   1028 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
   1029 
   1030 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
   1031 {
   1032   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
   1033 
   1034   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
   1035      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
   1036   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
   1037 
   1038   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
   1039   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
   1040   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
   1041 };
   1042 
   1043 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
   1044   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
   1045 
   1046 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
   1047   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
   1048 
   1049 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
   1050   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
   1051    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
   1052 
   1053 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
   1054 
   1055 static bool
   1056 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
   1057 {
   1058   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata));
   1059 }
   1060 
   1061 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
   1062 
   1063 bool
   1064 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
   1065 {
   1066   unsigned long mach = 0;
   1067   asection *s;
   1068   unsigned char *contents;
   1069 
   1070   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
   1071       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
   1072     {
   1073 
   1074       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   1075 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1076 	  break;
   1077       if (s != NULL)
   1078 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1079     }
   1080 
   1081   if (mach == 0)
   1082     {
   1083       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1084       if (s != NULL
   1085 	  && s->size >= 24
   1086 	  && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0
   1087 	  && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
   1088 	{
   1089 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
   1090 	  unsigned int i;
   1091 
   1092 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
   1093 	    {
   1094 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
   1095 	      switch (val >> 16)
   1096 		{
   1097 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
   1098 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
   1099 		  if (mach == 0)
   1100 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
   1101 		  break;
   1102 
   1103 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
   1104 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
   1105 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
   1106 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
   1107 		  break;
   1108 
   1109 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
   1110 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
   1111 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
   1112 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
   1113 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
   1114 		  break;
   1115 
   1116 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
   1117 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1118 		  break;
   1119 
   1120 		default:
   1121 		  mach = -1ul;
   1122 		}
   1123 	    }
   1124 	  free (contents);
   1125 	}
   1126     }
   1127 
   1128   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
   1129     {
   1130       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
   1131 
   1132       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
   1133 	if (arch->mach == mach)
   1134 	  {
   1135 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
   1136 	    break;
   1137 	  }
   1138     }
   1139   return true;
   1140 }
   1141 
   1142 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
   1143    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
   1144 
   1145 static bool
   1146 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
   1147 {
   1148   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
   1149     return true;
   1150 
   1151   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
   1152     {
   1153       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1154 
   1155       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   1156 	{
   1157 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
   1158 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
   1159 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
   1160 	}
   1161     }
   1162   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
   1163 }
   1164 
   1165 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
   1166 
   1167 static bool
   1168 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
   1169 {
   1170   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
   1171 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
   1172 
   1173   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
   1174   elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
   1175   return true;
   1176 }
   1177 
   1178 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
   1179 
   1180 static bool
   1181 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1182 {
   1183   int offset;
   1184   unsigned int size;
   1185 
   1186   switch (note->descsz)
   1187     {
   1188     default:
   1189       return false;
   1190 
   1191     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
   1192       /* pr_cursig */
   1193       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   1194 
   1195       /* pr_pid */
   1196       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
   1197 
   1198       /* pr_reg */
   1199       offset = 72;
   1200       size = 192;
   1201 
   1202       break;
   1203     }
   1204 
   1205   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   1206   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   1207 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   1208 }
   1209 
   1210 static bool
   1211 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1212 {
   1213   switch (note->descsz)
   1214     {
   1215     default:
   1216       return false;
   1217 
   1218     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
   1219       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   1220 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
   1221       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   1222 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
   1223       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   1224 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
   1225     }
   1226 
   1227   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   1228      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   1229      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   1230 
   1231   {
   1232     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   1233     int n = strlen (command);
   1234 
   1235     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   1236       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   1237   }
   1238 
   1239   return true;
   1240 }
   1241 
   1242 static char *
   1243 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
   1244 {
   1245   switch (note_type)
   1246     {
   1247     default:
   1248       return NULL;
   1249 
   1250     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   1251       {
   1252 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
   1253 	va_list ap;
   1254 
   1255 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1256 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
   1257 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
   1258 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1259 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
   1260 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
   1261 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
   1262 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
   1263 	 */
   1264 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
   1265 #endif
   1266 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
   1267 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1268 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
   1269 #endif
   1270 	va_end (ap);
   1271 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1272 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1273       }
   1274 
   1275     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   1276       {
   1277 	char data[268];
   1278 	va_list ap;
   1279 	long pid;
   1280 	int cursig;
   1281 	const void *greg;
   1282 
   1283 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1284 	memset (data, 0, 72);
   1285 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
   1286 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
   1287 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
   1288 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
   1289 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
   1290 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
   1291 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
   1292 	va_end (ap);
   1293 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1294 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1295       }
   1296     }
   1297 }
   1298 
   1299 static flagword
   1300 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
   1301 {
   1302 
   1303   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
   1304     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
   1305 
   1306   return 0;
   1307 }
   1308 
   1309 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
   1310    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
   1311 
   1312 static bfd_vma
   1313 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1314 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1315 		     const arelent *rel)
   1316 {
   1317   return rel->address;
   1318 }
   1319 
   1320 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
   1321    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
   1322    type.  */
   1323 
   1324 static bool
   1325 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   1326 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
   1327 			   const char *name,
   1328 			   int shindex)
   1329 {
   1330   asection *newsect;
   1331   flagword flags;
   1332 
   1333   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1334     return false;
   1335 
   1336   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
   1337   flags = 0;
   1338   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
   1339     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   1340 
   1341   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
   1342     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
   1343 
   1344   if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
   1345     name += 8;
   1346   if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
   1347       || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
   1348     flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
   1349 
   1350   return (flags == 0
   1351 	  || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
   1352 }
   1353 
   1354 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
   1355 
   1356 static bool
   1357 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1358 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
   1359 		       asection *asect)
   1360 {
   1361   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
   1362     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
   1363 
   1364   return true;
   1365 }
   1366 
   1367 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
   1368    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
   1369 
   1370 static int
   1371 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
   1372 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1373 {
   1374   asection *s;
   1375   int ret = 0;
   1376 
   1377   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
   1378   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1379     ++ret;
   1380 
   1381   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
   1382   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1383     ++ret;
   1384 
   1385   return ret;
   1386 }
   1387 
   1388 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
   1389 
   1390 bool
   1391 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   1392 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1393 {
   1394   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   1395 
   1396   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
   1397      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
   1398      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
   1399      If we find that case, we split the segment.
   1400      We maintain the original output section order.  */
   1401 
   1402   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   1403     {
   1404       struct elf_segment_map *n;
   1405       size_t amt;
   1406       unsigned int j, k;
   1407       unsigned int p_flags;
   1408 
   1409       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
   1410 	continue;
   1411 
   1412       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
   1413 	{
   1414 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1415 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
   1416 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1417 	    {
   1418 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
   1419 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1420 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1421 	      break;
   1422 	    }
   1423 	}
   1424       if (j != m->count)
   1425 	while (++j != m->count)
   1426 	  {
   1427 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
   1428 
   1429 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1430 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
   1431 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1432 	      {
   1433 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
   1434 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1435 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1436 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1437 		  break;
   1438 	      }
   1439 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
   1440 	  }
   1441       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
   1442 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
   1443 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
   1444 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
   1445       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
   1446 	{
   1447 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   1448 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
   1449 	}
   1450       if (j == m->count)
   1451 	continue;
   1452 
   1453       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
   1454 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
   1455 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
   1456 
   1457       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   1458       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   1459       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   1460       if (n == NULL)
   1461 	return false;
   1462 
   1463       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   1464       n->count = m->count - j;
   1465       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
   1466 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
   1467       m->count = j;
   1468       m->p_size_valid = 0;
   1469       n->next = m->next;
   1470       m->next = n;
   1471     }
   1472 
   1473   return true;
   1474 }
   1475 
   1476 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
   1477    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
   1478    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
   1479    2 sections.  */
   1480 
   1481 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
   1482 {
   1483   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   1484   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1485   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1486   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1487   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1488   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
   1489   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
   1490   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1491   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1492   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
   1493 };
   1494 
   1495 /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
   1496 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
   1497   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
   1498 
   1499 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   1500 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   1501 {
   1502   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   1503 
   1504   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   1505   if (sec->name == NULL)
   1506     return NULL;
   1507 
   1508   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
   1509 					sec->use_rela_p);
   1510   if (ssect != NULL)
   1511     {
   1512       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   1513 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
   1514       return ssect;
   1515     }
   1516 
   1517   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   1518 }
   1519 
   1520 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
   1522 typedef struct apuinfo_list
   1523 {
   1524   struct apuinfo_list *next;
   1525   unsigned long value;
   1526 }
   1527 apuinfo_list;
   1528 
   1529 static apuinfo_list *head;
   1530 static bool apuinfo_set;
   1531 
   1532 static void
   1533 apuinfo_list_init (void)
   1534 {
   1535   head = NULL;
   1536   apuinfo_set = false;
   1537 }
   1538 
   1539 static void
   1540 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
   1541 {
   1542   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
   1543 
   1544   while (entry != NULL)
   1545     {
   1546       if (entry->value == value)
   1547 	return;
   1548       entry = entry->next;
   1549     }
   1550 
   1551   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
   1552   if (entry == NULL)
   1553     return;
   1554 
   1555   entry->value = value;
   1556   entry->next  = head;
   1557   head = entry;
   1558 }
   1559 
   1560 static unsigned
   1561 apuinfo_list_length (void)
   1562 {
   1563   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1564   unsigned long count;
   1565 
   1566   for (entry = head, count = 0;
   1567        entry;
   1568        entry = entry->next)
   1569     ++ count;
   1570 
   1571   return count;
   1572 }
   1573 
   1574 static inline unsigned long
   1575 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
   1576 {
   1577   apuinfo_list * entry;
   1578 
   1579   for (entry = head;
   1580        entry && number --;
   1581        entry = entry->next)
   1582     ;
   1583 
   1584   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
   1585 }
   1586 
   1587 static void
   1588 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
   1589 {
   1590   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1591 
   1592   for (entry = head; entry;)
   1593     {
   1594       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
   1595       free (entry);
   1596       entry = next;
   1597     }
   1598 
   1599   head = NULL;
   1600 }
   1601 
   1602 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
   1603    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
   1604 
   1605 static void
   1606 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   1607 {
   1608   bfd *ibfd;
   1609   asection *asec;
   1610   char *buffer = NULL;
   1611   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
   1612   unsigned i;
   1613   unsigned long length;
   1614   const char *error_message = NULL;
   1615 
   1616   if (link_info == NULL)
   1617     return;
   1618 
   1619   apuinfo_list_init ();
   1620 
   1621   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
   1622   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   1623     {
   1624       unsigned long datum;
   1625 
   1626       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1627       if (asec == NULL)
   1628 	continue;
   1629 
   1630       /* xgettext:c-format */
   1631       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
   1632       length = asec->size;
   1633       if (length < 20)
   1634 	goto fail;
   1635 
   1636       apuinfo_set = true;
   1637       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
   1638 	{
   1639 	  free (buffer);
   1640 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
   1641 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
   1642 	  if (!buffer)
   1643 	    return;
   1644 	}
   1645 
   1646       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   1647 	  || (bfd_read (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
   1648 	{
   1649 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1650 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
   1651 	  goto fail;
   1652 	}
   1653 
   1654       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
   1655 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
   1656 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
   1657       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
   1658       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
   1659 	goto fail;
   1660 
   1661       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
   1662       if (datum != 0x2)
   1663 	goto fail;
   1664 
   1665       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
   1666 	goto fail;
   1667 
   1668       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
   1669       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
   1670       if (datum + 20 != length)
   1671 	goto fail;
   1672 
   1673       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
   1674       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
   1675 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
   1676     }
   1677 
   1678   error_message = NULL;
   1679 
   1680   if (apuinfo_set)
   1681     {
   1682       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
   1683       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1684 
   1685       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
   1686       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1687 
   1688       if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
   1689 	{
   1690 	  ibfd = abfd;
   1691 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1692 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
   1693 	}
   1694     }
   1695 
   1696  fail:
   1697   free (buffer);
   1698 
   1699   if (error_message)
   1700     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
   1701 }
   1702 
   1703 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
   1704    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
   1705 
   1706 static bool
   1707 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1708 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1709 		       asection *asec,
   1710 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1711 {
   1712   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
   1713 }
   1714 
   1715 /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
   1716 
   1717 static void
   1718 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1719 {
   1720   bfd_byte *buffer;
   1721   asection *asec;
   1722   unsigned i;
   1723   unsigned num_entries;
   1724   bfd_size_type length;
   1725 
   1726   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1727   if (asec == NULL)
   1728     return;
   1729 
   1730   if (!apuinfo_set)
   1731     return;
   1732 
   1733   length = asec->size;
   1734   if (length < 20)
   1735     return;
   1736 
   1737   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
   1738   if (buffer == NULL)
   1739     {
   1740       _bfd_error_handler
   1741 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
   1742       return;
   1743     }
   1744 
   1745   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
   1746   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1747   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
   1748   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
   1749   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
   1750   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
   1751 
   1752   length = 20;
   1753   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
   1754     {
   1755       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
   1756       length += 4;
   1757     }
   1758 
   1759   if (length != asec->size)
   1760     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
   1761 
   1762   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
   1763     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
   1764 
   1765   free (buffer);
   1766 
   1767   apuinfo_list_finish ();
   1768 }
   1769 
   1770 static bool
   1771 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1772 {
   1773   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1774   return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1775 }
   1776 
   1777 static bool
   1779 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
   1780 {
   1781   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
   1782 
   1783   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
   1784     return false;
   1785 
   1786   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
   1787 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
   1788 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
   1789 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
   1790 }
   1791 
   1792 static bool
   1793 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
   1794 {
   1795   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
   1796   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   1797 	  && section->vma <= vma
   1798 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
   1799 }
   1800 
   1801 static long
   1802 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
   1803 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
   1804 			      asymbol **ret)
   1805 {
   1806   bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
   1807   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
   1808   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
   1809   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
   1810   bfd_vma stub_off;
   1811   asymbol *s;
   1812   arelent *p;
   1813   size_t count, i, stub_delta;
   1814   size_t size;
   1815   char *names;
   1816   bfd_byte buf[4];
   1817 
   1818   *ret = NULL;
   1819 
   1820   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   1821     return 0;
   1822 
   1823   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   1824     return 0;
   1825 
   1826   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
   1827   if (relplt == NULL)
   1828     return 0;
   1829 
   1830   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   1831   if (plt == NULL)
   1832     return 0;
   1833 
   1834   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
   1835   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
   1836     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
   1837 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
   1838 
   1839   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
   1840      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
   1841   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1842   if (dynamic != NULL
   1843       && (dynamic->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
   1844     {
   1845       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1846       size_t extdynsize;
   1847       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1848 
   1849       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
   1850 	return -1;
   1851 
   1852       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1853       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1854 
   1855       for (extdyn = dynbuf, extdynend = dynbuf + dynamic->size;
   1856 	   (size_t) (extdynend - extdyn) >= extdynsize;
   1857 	   extdyn += extdynsize)
   1858 	{
   1859 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1860 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1861 
   1862 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1863 	    break;
   1864 
   1865 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
   1866 	    {
   1867 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1868 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
   1869 	      if (got != NULL
   1870 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
   1871 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
   1872 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1873 	      break;
   1874 	    }
   1875 	}
   1876       free (dynbuf);
   1877     }
   1878 
   1879   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
   1880   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1881     {
   1882       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
   1883 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1884     }
   1885 
   1886   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1887     return 0;
   1888 
   1889   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
   1890      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
   1891      glink stubs now reside.  */
   1892   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
   1893   if (glink == NULL)
   1894     return 0;
   1895 
   1896   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
   1897      from the first glink stub.  */
   1898   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1899 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
   1900     {
   1901       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1902 
   1903       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
   1904       insn ^= B;
   1905       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
   1906 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
   1907 
   1908       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
   1909       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
   1910 	for (i = 4;
   1911 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1912 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
   1913 	     i += 4)
   1914 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
   1915 	    {
   1916 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
   1917 	      break;
   1918 	    }
   1919     }
   1920 
   1921   count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr);
   1922   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
   1923      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
   1924      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
   1925      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
   1926      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
   1927      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   1928   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1929   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
   1930     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
   1931       break;
   1932   if (stub_delta > 32)
   1933     return 0;
   1934 
   1935   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   1936   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
   1937     return -1;
   1938 
   1939   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   1940   p = relplt->relocation;
   1941   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
   1942     {
   1943       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   1944       if (p->addend != 0)
   1945 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   1946     }
   1947 
   1948   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
   1949 
   1950   if (resolv_vma)
   1951     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   1952 
   1953   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
   1954   if (s == NULL)
   1955     return -1;
   1956 
   1957   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1958   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
   1959   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
   1960   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   1961     {
   1962       size_t len;
   1963 
   1964       stub_off -= stub_delta;
   1965       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
   1966 	stub_off -= 32;
   1967       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   1968       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   1969 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   1970       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   1971 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   1972       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1973       s->section = glink;
   1974       s->value = stub_off;
   1975       s->name = names;
   1976       s->udata.p = NULL;
   1977       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   1978       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   1979       names += len;
   1980       if (p->addend != 0)
   1981 	{
   1982 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   1983 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   1984 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
   1985 	  names += strlen (names);
   1986 	}
   1987       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   1988       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   1989       ++s;
   1990       --p;
   1991     }
   1992 
   1993   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
   1994   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   1995   s->the_bfd = abfd;
   1996   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1997   s->section = glink;
   1998   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1999   s->name = names;
   2000   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
   2001   names += sizeof ("__glink");
   2002   s++;
   2003   count++;
   2004 
   2005   if (resolv_vma)
   2006     {
   2007       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
   2008       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   2009       s->the_bfd = abfd;
   2010       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   2011       s->section = glink;
   2012       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
   2013       s->name = names;
   2014       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
   2015       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   2016       s++;
   2017       count++;
   2018     }
   2019 
   2020   return count;
   2021 }
   2022 
   2023 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
   2025    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
   2026    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
   2027    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
   2028    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
   2029    called.  */
   2030 
   2031 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
   2032    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
   2033 struct plt_entry
   2034 {
   2035   struct plt_entry *next;
   2036 
   2037   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
   2038      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
   2039      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
   2040      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
   2041      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
   2042   bfd_vma addend;
   2043 
   2044   /* The .got2 section.  */
   2045   asection *sec;
   2046 
   2047   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
   2048   union
   2049     {
   2050       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2051       bfd_vma offset;
   2052     } plt;
   2053 
   2054   /* .glink stub offset.  */
   2055   bfd_vma glink_offset;
   2056 };
   2057 
   2058 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
   2059    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
   2060    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
   2061 
   2062 static int
   2063 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2064 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2065 {
   2066   switch (r_type)
   2067     {
   2068     default:
   2069       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
   2070 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
   2071 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
   2072 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
   2073       return 1;
   2074 
   2075     case R_PPC_REL24:
   2076     case R_PPC_REL14:
   2077     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   2078     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   2079     case R_PPC_REL32:
   2080       return 0;
   2081 
   2082     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   2083     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   2084     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   2085     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   2086     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   2087       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
   2088 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
   2089       return bfd_link_dll (info);
   2090     }
   2091 }
   2092 
   2093 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
   2094    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
   2095    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
   2096    shared lib.  */
   2097 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
   2098 
   2099 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
   2100 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
   2101 {
   2102   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
   2103 
   2104   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
   2105   asection *sec;
   2106 
   2107   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
   2108   unsigned int count : 31;
   2109 
   2110   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
   2111   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
   2112 };
   2113 
   2114 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
   2115 
   2116 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
   2117 {
   2118   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
   2119 
   2120   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
   2121      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
   2122      from the beginning of the section.  */
   2123   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
   2124 
   2125   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
   2126      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
   2127      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
   2128      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
   2129      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
   2130      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
   2131      set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
   2132      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
   2133 #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
   2134 #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
   2135 #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
   2136 #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
   2137 #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
   2138 #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
   2139 #define TLS_GDIE	64	/* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
   2140   unsigned char tls_mask;
   2141 
   2142   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
   2143      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
   2144 #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   2145 #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
   2146 #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
   2147 
   2148   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
   2149      symbol.  */
   2150   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
   2151 
   2152   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
   2153   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
   2154   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
   2155 };
   2156 
   2157 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
   2158 
   2159 /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2160 
   2161 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
   2162 {
   2163   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
   2164 
   2165   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
   2166   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
   2167 
   2168   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
   2169   asection *glink;
   2170   asection *dynsbss;
   2171   asection *relsbss;
   2172   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
   2173   asection *sbss;
   2174   asection *glink_eh_frame;
   2175   asection *pltlocal;
   2176   asection *relpltlocal;
   2177 
   2178   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
   2179   asection *srelplt2;
   2180 
   2181   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
   2182   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
   2183 
   2184   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
   2185   bfd *old_bfd;
   2186 
   2187   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
   2188   union {
   2189     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2190     bfd_vma offset;
   2191   } tlsld_got;
   2192 
   2193   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
   2194   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
   2195 
   2196   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
   2197   unsigned int got_header_size;
   2198   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
   2199   unsigned int got_gap;
   2200 
   2201   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
   2202   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
   2203 
   2204   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
   2205      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
   2206   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2207   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2208 
   2209   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
   2210   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
   2211 
   2212   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
   2213   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
   2214 
   2215   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
   2216   int plt_entry_size;
   2217   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
   2218   int plt_slot_size;
   2219   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
   2220   int plt_initial_entry_size;
   2221 };
   2222 
   2223 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
   2224    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
   2225 
   2226 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
   2227 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
   2228 
   2229 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
   2230    relocs.  */
   2231 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
   2232 
   2233   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
   2234 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
   2235 
   2236 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
   2237 
   2238 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
   2239   ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash)					\
   2240     && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)	\
   2241    ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
   2242 
   2243 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2244 
   2245 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
   2246 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
   2247 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
   2248 			   const char *string)
   2249 {
   2250   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
   2251      subclass.  */
   2252   if (entry == NULL)
   2253     {
   2254       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
   2255 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
   2256       if (entry == NULL)
   2257 	return entry;
   2258     }
   2259 
   2260   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
   2261   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
   2262   if (entry != NULL)
   2263     {
   2264       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
   2265       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
   2266       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
   2267     }
   2268 
   2269   return entry;
   2270 }
   2271 
   2272 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2273 
   2274 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   2275 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   2276 {
   2277   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
   2278   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
   2279     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
   2280 
   2281   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
   2282   if (ret == NULL)
   2283     return NULL;
   2284 
   2285   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
   2286 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
   2287 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry)))
   2288     {
   2289       free (ret);
   2290       return NULL;
   2291     }
   2292 
   2293   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
   2294   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
   2295   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
   2296   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
   2297 
   2298   ret->params = &default_params;
   2299 
   2300   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
   2301   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
   2302   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
   2303 
   2304   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
   2305   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
   2306   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
   2307 
   2308   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
   2309   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
   2310   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
   2311 
   2312   return &ret->elf.root;
   2313 }
   2314 
   2315 /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
   2316 
   2317 void
   2318 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
   2319 {
   2320   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2321 
   2322   if (htab)
   2323     htab->params = params;
   2324   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
   2325 }
   2326 
   2327 /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
   2328 
   2329 static bool
   2330 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2331 {
   2332   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2333 
   2334   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
   2335     return false;
   2336 
   2337   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2338   if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2339     {
   2340       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
   2341 	 executable.  */
   2342       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2343 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2344       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   2345 	return false;
   2346     }
   2347 
   2348   return true;
   2349 }
   2350 
   2351 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
   2352    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
   2353    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
   2354 
   2355 static bool
   2356 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2357 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2358 			       flagword flags,
   2359 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2360 {
   2361   asection *s;
   2362 
   2363   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
   2364 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2365 
   2366   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
   2367   if (s == NULL)
   2368     return false;
   2369   lsect->section = s;
   2370 
   2371   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
   2372   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
   2373 
   2374   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
   2375   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
   2376     return false;
   2377   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
   2378   return true;
   2379 }
   2380 
   2381 static bool
   2382 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2383 {
   2384   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2385   asection *s;
   2386   flagword flags;
   2387   int p2align;
   2388 
   2389   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2390 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2391   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
   2392   htab->glink = s;
   2393   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
   2394   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
   2395     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
   2396   if (s == NULL
   2397       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
   2398     return false;
   2399 
   2400   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
   2401     {
   2402       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2403 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2404       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
   2405       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
   2406       if (s == NULL
   2407 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2408 	return false;
   2409     }
   2410 
   2411   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2412   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
   2413   htab->elf.iplt = s;
   2414   if (s == NULL
   2415       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
   2416     return false;
   2417 
   2418   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2419 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2420   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
   2421   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
   2422   if (s == NULL
   2423       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2424     return false;
   2425 
   2426   /* Local plt entries.  */
   2427   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
   2428 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2429   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
   2430 						       flags);
   2431   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
   2432       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
   2433     return false;
   2434 
   2435   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   2436     {
   2437       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
   2438 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2439       htab->relpltlocal
   2440 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
   2441       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
   2442 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
   2443 	return false;
   2444     }
   2445 
   2446   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
   2447 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
   2448     return false;
   2449 
   2450   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
   2451 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
   2452     return false;
   2453 
   2454   return true;
   2455 }
   2456 
   2457 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
   2458    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
   2459    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
   2460 
   2461 static bool
   2462 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2463 {
   2464   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2465   asection *s;
   2466   flagword flags;
   2467 
   2468   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2469 
   2470   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2471       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
   2472     return false;
   2473 
   2474   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
   2475     return false;
   2476 
   2477   if (htab->glink == NULL
   2478       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
   2479     return false;
   2480 
   2481   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
   2482 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2483   htab->dynsbss = s;
   2484   if (s == NULL)
   2485     return false;
   2486 
   2487   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   2488     {
   2489       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2490 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2491       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
   2492       htab->relsbss = s;
   2493       if (s == NULL
   2494 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2495 	return false;
   2496     }
   2497 
   2498   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   2499       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
   2500     return false;
   2501 
   2502   s = htab->elf.splt;
   2503   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2504   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   2505     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
   2506     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
   2507   return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
   2508 }
   2509 
   2510 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
   2511 
   2512 static void
   2513 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2514 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
   2515 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
   2516 {
   2517   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
   2518 
   2519   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
   2520   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
   2521 
   2522   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
   2523   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
   2524 
   2525   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
   2526     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
   2527   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
   2528   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
   2529   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
   2530   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
   2531   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
   2532 
   2533   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
   2534   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   2535     return;
   2536 
   2537   if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2538     {
   2539       if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2540 	{
   2541 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   2542 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   2543 
   2544 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
   2545 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
   2546 	  for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   2547 	    {
   2548 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
   2549 
   2550 	      for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
   2551 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
   2552 		  {
   2553 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
   2554 		    q->count += p->count;
   2555 		    *pp = p->next;
   2556 		    break;
   2557 		  }
   2558 	      if (q == NULL)
   2559 		pp = &p->next;
   2560 	    }
   2561 	  *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
   2562 	}
   2563 
   2564       dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
   2565       ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   2566     }
   2567 
   2568   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
   2569      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
   2570   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
   2571   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
   2572 
   2573   /* And plt entries.  */
   2574   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2575     {
   2576       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2577 	{
   2578 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
   2579 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   2580 
   2581 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
   2582 	    {
   2583 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
   2584 
   2585 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
   2586 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
   2587 		  {
   2588 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
   2589 		    *entp = ent->next;
   2590 		    break;
   2591 		  }
   2592 	      if (dent == NULL)
   2593 		entp = &ent->next;
   2594 	    }
   2595 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
   2596 	}
   2597 
   2598       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
   2599       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
   2600     }
   2601 
   2602   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2603     {
   2604       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2605 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   2606 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
   2607       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
   2608       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
   2609       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
   2610       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
   2611     }
   2612 }
   2613 
   2614 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
   2615    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
   2616 
   2617 static bool
   2618 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   2619 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2620 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   2621 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2622 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2623 			 asection **secp,
   2624 			 bfd_vma *valp)
   2625 {
   2626   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
   2627       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   2628       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
   2629       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
   2630     {
   2631       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
   2632 	 put into .sbss.  */
   2633       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2634 
   2635       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2636       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2637 	{
   2638 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2639 
   2640 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
   2641 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2642 
   2643 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
   2644 							   ".sbss",
   2645 							   flags);
   2646 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2647 	    return false;
   2648 	}
   2649 
   2650       *secp = htab->sbss;
   2651       *valp = sym->st_size;
   2652     }
   2653 
   2654   return true;
   2655 }
   2656 
   2657 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
   2659 
   2660 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
   2661 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
   2662   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
   2663    bfd_vma addend,
   2664    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2665 {
   2666   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
   2667     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
   2668       return linker_pointers;
   2669 
   2670   return NULL;
   2671 }
   2672 
   2673 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
   2674 
   2675 static bool
   2676 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2677 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   2678 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   2679 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   2680 {
   2681   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
   2682   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   2683   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2684   bfd_size_type amt;
   2685 
   2686   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   2687 
   2688   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
   2689   if (h != NULL)
   2690     {
   2691       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   2692 
   2693       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2694       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   2695       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
   2696 					   rel->r_addend,
   2697 					   lsect))
   2698 	return true;
   2699 
   2700       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
   2701     }
   2702   else
   2703     {
   2704       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2705 
   2706       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
   2707       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
   2708 
   2709       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
   2710       if (!ptr)
   2711 	{
   2712 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
   2713 
   2714 	  amt = num_symbols;
   2715 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
   2716 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2717 
   2718 	  if (!ptr)
   2719 	    return false;
   2720 
   2721 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
   2722 	}
   2723 
   2724       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2725       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
   2726 					   rel->r_addend,
   2727 					   lsect))
   2728 	return true;
   2729 
   2730       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
   2731     }
   2732 
   2733   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
   2734      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
   2735   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   2736   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
   2737   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2738 
   2739   if (!linker_section_ptr)
   2740     return false;
   2741 
   2742   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
   2743   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
   2744   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
   2745   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
   2746 
   2747   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
   2748     return false;
   2749   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
   2750   lsect->section->size += 4;
   2751 
   2752 #ifdef DEBUG
   2753   fprintf (stderr,
   2754 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
   2755 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
   2756 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
   2757 #endif
   2758 
   2759   return true;
   2760 }
   2761 
   2762 static struct plt_entry **
   2763 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
   2764 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
   2765 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
   2766 		       int tls_type)
   2767 {
   2768   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
   2769   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   2770   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
   2771 
   2772   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2773     {
   2774       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   2775 
   2776       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
   2777 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
   2778 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
   2779       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
   2780       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2781 	return NULL;
   2782       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
   2783     }
   2784 
   2785   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2786   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2787   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
   2788   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
   2789     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
   2790   return local_plt + r_symndx;
   2791 }
   2792 
   2793 static bool
   2794 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
   2795 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2796 {
   2797   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2798 
   2799   if (addend < 32768)
   2800     sec = NULL;
   2801   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2802     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2803       break;
   2804   if (ent == NULL)
   2805     {
   2806       size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
   2807       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2808       if (ent == NULL)
   2809 	return false;
   2810       ent->next = *plist;
   2811       ent->sec = sec;
   2812       ent->addend = addend;
   2813       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
   2814       *plist = ent;
   2815     }
   2816   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
   2817   return true;
   2818 }
   2819 
   2820 static struct plt_entry *
   2821 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2822 {
   2823   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2824 
   2825   if (addend < 32768)
   2826     sec = NULL;
   2827   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2828     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2829       break;
   2830   return ent;
   2831 }
   2832 
   2833 static bool
   2834 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2835 {
   2836   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2837 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
   2838 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
   2839 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
   2840 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   2841 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
   2842 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
   2843 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
   2844 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
   2845 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
   2846 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
   2847 }
   2848 
   2849 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
   2850 
   2851 static bool
   2852 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2853 {
   2854   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
   2855 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2856 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2857 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
   2858 }
   2859 
   2860 /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto.  Return true
   2861    iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits.  */
   2862 
   2863 static bool
   2864 offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
   2865 {
   2866   return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
   2867 }
   2868 
   2869 static void
   2870 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2871 {
   2872   _bfd_error_handler
   2873     /* xgettext:c-format */
   2874     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
   2875      abfd,
   2876      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
   2877   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   2878 }
   2879 
   2880 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
   2881    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
   2882    table.  */
   2883 
   2884 static bool
   2885 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   2886 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2887 		      asection *sec,
   2888 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
   2889 {
   2890   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2891   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2892   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   2893   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   2894   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
   2895   asection *got2, *sreloc;
   2896   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
   2897 
   2898   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   2899     return true;
   2900 
   2901 #ifdef DEBUG
   2902   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
   2903 		      sec, abfd);
   2904 #endif
   2905 
   2906   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2907 
   2908   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   2909   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   2910     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   2911 
   2912   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2913   if (htab->glink == NULL)
   2914     {
   2915       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2916 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2917       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2918 	return false;
   2919     }
   2920   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   2921 			      false, false, true);
   2922   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   2923   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
   2924   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   2925   sreloc = NULL;
   2926 
   2927   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
   2928   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
   2929     {
   2930       unsigned long r_symndx;
   2931       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   2932       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   2933       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   2934       int tls_type;
   2935       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
   2936       struct plt_entry **pltent;
   2937       bfd_vma addend;
   2938 
   2939       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2940       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   2941 	{
   2942 	  h = NULL;
   2943 	  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
   2944 	  if (isym == NULL)
   2945 	    return false;
   2946 	}
   2947       else
   2948 	{
   2949 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   2950 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   2951 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   2952 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   2953 	  isym = NULL;
   2954 	}
   2955 
   2956       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
   2957 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
   2958 	 startup code.  */
   2959       if (h != NULL
   2960 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2961 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
   2962 	{
   2963 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2964 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2965 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2966 	    return false;
   2967 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
   2968 	}
   2969 
   2970       tls_type = 0;
   2971       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   2972       ifunc = NULL;
   2973       if (h != NULL)
   2974 	{
   2975 	  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2976 	    {
   2977 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   2978 	      ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   2979 	    }
   2980 	}
   2981       else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2982 	{
   2983 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2984 	    {
   2985 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
   2986 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   2987 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
   2988 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
   2989 		return false;
   2990 
   2991 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
   2992 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
   2993 		 no plt calls.  */
   2994 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   2995 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   2996 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2997 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2998 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
   2999 		{
   3000 		  addend = 0;
   3001 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3002 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3003 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3004 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3005 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3006 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3007 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3008 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3009 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
   3010 		    return false;
   3011 		}
   3012 	    }
   3013 	}
   3014 
   3015       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   3016 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   3017 	  && h != NULL
   3018 	  && h == tga)
   3019 	{
   3020 	  if (rel != relocs
   3021 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
   3022 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
   3023 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
   3024 	       reloc.  */
   3025 	    ;
   3026 	  else
   3027 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
   3028 	    sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
   3029 	}
   3030 
   3031       switch (r_type)
   3032 	{
   3033 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   3034 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   3035 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
   3036 	     its parameter symbol.  */
   3037 	  if (h != NULL)
   3038 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
   3039 	  else
   3040 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3041 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   3042 	      return false;
   3043 	  break;
   3044 
   3045 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   3046 	  break;
   3047 
   3048 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   3049 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   3050 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   3051 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   3052 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   3053 	  goto dogottls;
   3054 
   3055 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   3056 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   3057 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   3058 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   3059 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   3060 	  goto dogottls;
   3061 
   3062 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   3063 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   3064 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   3065 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   3066 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3067 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3068 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   3069 	  goto dogottls;
   3070 
   3071 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   3072 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   3073 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   3074 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   3075 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   3076 	dogottls:
   3077 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3078 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3079 
   3080 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
   3081 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   3082 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   3083 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   3084 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   3085 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
   3086 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   3087 	    {
   3088 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3089 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3090 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   3091 		return false;
   3092 	    }
   3093 	  if (h != NULL)
   3094 	    {
   3095 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
   3096 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
   3097 	    }
   3098 	  else
   3099 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
   3100 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
   3101 	      return false;
   3102 
   3103 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3104 	     an ifunc.  */
   3105 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3106 	    {
   3107 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3108 		return false;
   3109 	    }
   3110 	  break;
   3111 
   3112 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   3113 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   3114 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3115 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   3116 						    h, rel))
   3117 	    return false;
   3118 	  if (h != NULL)
   3119 	    {
   3120 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3121 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3122 	    }
   3123 	  break;
   3124 
   3125 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   3126 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   3127 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3128 	    {
   3129 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3130 	      return false;
   3131 	    }
   3132 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3133 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   3134 						    h, rel))
   3135 	    return false;
   3136 	  if (h != NULL)
   3137 	    {
   3138 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3139 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3140 	    }
   3141 	  break;
   3142 
   3143 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   3144 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3145 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3146 
   3147 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   3148 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   3149 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   3150 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   3151 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   3152 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   3153 	  if (h != NULL)
   3154 	    {
   3155 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3156 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3157 	    }
   3158 	  break;
   3159 
   3160 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   3161 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   3162 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   3163 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   3164 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   3165 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   3166 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   3167 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   3168 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   3169 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   3170 	  break;
   3171 
   3172 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   3173 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3174 	    {
   3175 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3176 	      return false;
   3177 	    }
   3178 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3179 	  if (h != NULL)
   3180 	    {
   3181 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3182 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3183 	    }
   3184 	  break;
   3185 
   3186 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   3187 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   3188 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   3189 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   3190 	  if (h != NULL)
   3191 	    {
   3192 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3193 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3194 	    }
   3195 	  break;
   3196 
   3197 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   3198 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   3199 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   3200 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   3201 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   3202 	  if (h != NULL)
   3203 	    h->non_got_ref = true;
   3204 	  break;
   3205 
   3206 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   3207 	  if (h == NULL)
   3208 	    break;
   3209 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3210 	  goto pltentry;
   3211 
   3212 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   3213 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
   3214 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3215 
   3216 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   3217 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   3218 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   3219 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   3220 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   3221 	pltentry:
   3222 #ifdef DEBUG
   3223 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
   3224 #endif
   3225 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
   3226 	  if (h == NULL)
   3227 	    {
   3228 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3229 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
   3230 	      if (pltent == NULL)
   3231 		return false;
   3232 	    }
   3233 	  else
   3234 	    {
   3235 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3236 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
   3237 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3238 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
   3239 	    }
   3240 	  addend = 0;
   3241 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3242 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3243 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3244 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3245 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3246 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3247 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
   3248 	    return false;
   3249 	  break;
   3250 
   3251 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
   3252 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
   3253 	     section relative.  */
   3254 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   3255 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   3256 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   3257 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   3258 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   3259 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   3260 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   3261 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   3262 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
   3263 	  break;
   3264 
   3265 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   3266 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   3267 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   3268 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   3269 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   3270 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
   3271 	  break;
   3272 
   3273 	  /* These are just markers.  */
   3274 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   3275 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   3276 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   3277 	case R_PPC_max:
   3278 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   3279 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   3280 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   3281 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
   3282 	  break;
   3283 
   3284 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
   3285 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   3286 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   3287 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   3288 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   3289 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   3290 	  break;
   3291 
   3292 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
   3293 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   3294 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   3295 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   3296 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   3297 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   3298 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   3299 	  break;
   3300 
   3301 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
   3302 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   3303 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3304 	    {
   3305 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3306 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3307 	    }
   3308 	  if (h != NULL
   3309 	      && ifunc != NULL
   3310 	      && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
   3311 	    return false;
   3312 	  break;
   3313 
   3314 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
   3315 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
   3316 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   3317 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
   3318 	    return false;
   3319 	  break;
   3320 
   3321 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
   3322 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
   3323 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   3324 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
   3325 	    return false;
   3326 	  break;
   3327 
   3328 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   3329 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   3330 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3331 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3332 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
   3333 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   3334 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   3335 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   3336 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3337 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3338 	  goto dodyn;
   3339 
   3340 	  /* Nor these.  */
   3341 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   3342 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   3343 	  goto dodyn;
   3344 
   3345 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   3346 	  if (h == NULL
   3347 	      && got2 != NULL
   3348 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   3349 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
   3350 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3351 	    {
   3352 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
   3353 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
   3354 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
   3355 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
   3356 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
   3357 		 PLT call stubs.  */
   3358 	      asection *s;
   3359 
   3360 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3361 	      if (s == got2)
   3362 		{
   3363 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3364 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3365 		}
   3366 	    }
   3367 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3368 	    break;
   3369 	  /* fall through */
   3370 
   3371 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   3372 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   3373 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   3374 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   3375 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   3376 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   3377 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   3378 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3379 	    {
   3380 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3381 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3382 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3383 		return false;
   3384 
   3385 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
   3386 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
   3387 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
   3388 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   3389 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
   3390 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   3391 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
   3392 	    }
   3393 	  goto dodyn;
   3394 
   3395 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   3396 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   3397 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   3398 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   3399 	  if (h == NULL)
   3400 	    break;
   3401 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3402 	    {
   3403 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3404 		{
   3405 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3406 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3407 		}
   3408 	      break;
   3409 	    }
   3410 	  /* fall through */
   3411 
   3412 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   3413 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   3414 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   3415 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   3416 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3417 	    {
   3418 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3419 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3420 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3421 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3422 		return false;
   3423 	      break;
   3424 	    }
   3425 
   3426 	dodyn:
   3427 	  /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
   3428 	     relocations.  At this point in linking we have read all
   3429 	     the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
   3430 	     yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
   3431 	     symbol flags.  In some cases we might be setting dynamic
   3432 	     reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
   3433 	     That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
   3434 	     work together with this code.  */
   3435 	  if ((h != NULL
   3436 	       && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   3437 	      || (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3438 		  && (h != NULL
   3439 		      ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
   3440 		      : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
   3441 		  && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   3442 	    {
   3443 #ifdef DEBUG
   3444 	      fprintf (stderr,
   3445 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
   3446 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   3447 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   3448 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   3449 #endif
   3450 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   3451 		{
   3452 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3453 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3454 
   3455 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
   3456 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
   3457 
   3458 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
   3459 		    return false;
   3460 		}
   3461 
   3462 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
   3463 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
   3464 	      if (h != NULL)
   3465 		{
   3466 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   3467 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3468 
   3469 		  rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
   3470 		  p = *rel_head;
   3471 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
   3472 		    {
   3473 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3474 		      if (p == NULL)
   3475 			return false;
   3476 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3477 		      *rel_head = p;
   3478 		      p->sec = sec;
   3479 		      p->count = 0;
   3480 		      p->pc_count = 0;
   3481 		    }
   3482 		  p->count += 1;
   3483 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
   3484 		    p->pc_count += 1;
   3485 		}
   3486 	      else
   3487 		{
   3488 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
   3489 		     We really need local syms available to do this
   3490 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
   3491 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   3492 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3493 		  bool is_ifunc;
   3494 		  asection *s;
   3495 		  void *vpp;
   3496 
   3497 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3498 		  if (s == NULL)
   3499 		    s = sec;
   3500 
   3501 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
   3502 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
   3503 		  is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
   3504 		  p = *rel_head;
   3505 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3506 		    p = p->next;
   3507 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3508 		    {
   3509 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3510 		      if (p == NULL)
   3511 			return false;
   3512 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3513 		      *rel_head = p;
   3514 		      p->sec = sec;
   3515 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
   3516 		      p->count = 0;
   3517 		    }
   3518 		  p->count += 1;
   3519 		}
   3520 	    }
   3521 
   3522 	  break;
   3523 	}
   3524     }
   3525 
   3526   return true;
   3527 }
   3528 
   3529 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
   3531    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3532 bool
   3533 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3534 {
   3535   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3536   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3537   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3538   bool ret = true;
   3539   bool warn_only;
   3540 
   3541   /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
   3542      libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
   3543      but actually support more than one variant.  For example, glibc
   3544      typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
   3545      but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
   3546      The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
   3547      object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
   3548      layer objects and only from there call into the shared library.  */
   3549   warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
   3550 
   3551   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3552   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3553 
   3554   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3555   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3556 
   3557   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3558     {
   3559       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
   3560       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
   3561       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
   3562 
   3563       if (in_fp == 0)
   3564 	;
   3565       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3566 	{
   3567 	  if (!warn_only)
   3568 	    {
   3569 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3570 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3571 	      last_fp = ibfd;
   3572 	    }
   3573 	}
   3574       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
   3575 	{
   3576 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3577 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3578 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3579 	     last_fp, ibfd);
   3580 	  ret = warn_only;
   3581 	}
   3582       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
   3583 	{
   3584 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3585 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3586 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3587 	     ibfd, last_fp);
   3588 	  ret = warn_only;
   3589 	}
   3590       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
   3591 	{
   3592 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3593 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3594 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3595 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
   3596 	  ret = warn_only;
   3597 	}
   3598       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
   3599 	{
   3600 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3601 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3602 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3603 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
   3604 	  ret = warn_only;
   3605 	}
   3606 
   3607       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
   3608       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
   3609       if (in_fp == 0)
   3610 	;
   3611       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3612 	{
   3613 	  if (!warn_only)
   3614 	    {
   3615 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3616 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3617 	      last_ld = ibfd;
   3618 	    }
   3619 	}
   3620       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
   3621 	{
   3622 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3623 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3624 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3625 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3626 	  ret = warn_only;
   3627 	}
   3628       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
   3629 	{
   3630 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3631 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3632 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3633 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3634 	  ret = warn_only;
   3635 	}
   3636       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
   3637 	{
   3638 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3639 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3640 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3641 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3642 	  ret = warn_only;
   3643 	}
   3644       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
   3645 	{
   3646 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3647 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3648 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3649 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3650 	  ret = warn_only;
   3651 	}
   3652     }
   3653 
   3654   if (!ret)
   3655     {
   3656       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3657       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3658     }
   3659   return ret;
   3660 }
   3661 
   3662 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
   3663    there are conflicting attributes.  */
   3664 static bool
   3665 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3666 {
   3667   bfd *obfd;
   3668   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3669   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3670   bool ret;
   3671 
   3672   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3673     return false;
   3674 
   3675   obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3676   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3677   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3678 
   3679   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
   3680      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3681   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3682   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3683   ret = true;
   3684   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3685     {
   3686       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
   3687       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
   3688       static bfd *last_vec;
   3689 
   3690       if (in_vec == 0)
   3691 	;
   3692       else if (out_vec == 0)
   3693 	{
   3694 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3695 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3696 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3697 	}
   3698       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
   3699 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
   3700 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
   3701 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
   3702 	 case too.  */
   3703       else if (in_vec == 1)
   3704 	;
   3705       else if (out_vec == 1)
   3706 	{
   3707 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3708 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3709 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3710 	}
   3711       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
   3712 	{
   3713 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3714 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3715 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3716 	     last_vec, ibfd);
   3717 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3718 	  ret = false;
   3719 	}
   3720       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
   3721 	{
   3722 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3723 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3724 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3725 	     ibfd, last_vec);
   3726 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3727 	  ret = false;
   3728 	}
   3729     }
   3730 
   3731   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
   3732      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3733   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3734   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3735   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3736     {
   3737       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
   3738       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
   3739       static bfd *last_struct;
   3740 
   3741       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
   3742        ;
   3743       else if (out_struct == 0)
   3744 	{
   3745 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3746 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
   3747 	  last_struct = ibfd;
   3748 	}
   3749       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
   3750 	{
   3751 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3752 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3753 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3754 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
   3755 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3756 	  ret = false;
   3757 	}
   3758       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
   3759 	{
   3760 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3761 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3762 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3763 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
   3764 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3765 	  ret = false;
   3766 	}
   3767     }
   3768   if (!ret)
   3769     {
   3770       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3771       return false;
   3772     }
   3773 
   3774   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
   3775   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
   3776 }
   3777 
   3778 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
   3779    object file when linking.  */
   3780 
   3781 static bool
   3782 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3783 {
   3784   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3785   flagword old_flags;
   3786   flagword new_flags;
   3787   bool error;
   3788 
   3789   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
   3790     return true;
   3791 
   3792   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
   3793   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
   3794     return false;
   3795 
   3796   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3797     return false;
   3798 
   3799   if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   3800     return true;
   3801 
   3802   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   3803   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
   3804   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   3805     {
   3806       /* First call, no flags set.  */
   3807       elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
   3808       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
   3809     }
   3810 
   3811   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
   3812   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
   3813     ;
   3814 
   3815   /* Incompatible flags.  */
   3816   else
   3817     {
   3818       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
   3819 	 to be linked with either.  */
   3820       error = false;
   3821       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
   3822 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
   3823 	{
   3824 	  error = true;
   3825 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3826 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
   3827 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
   3828 	}
   3829       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
   3830 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
   3831 	{
   3832 	  error = true;
   3833 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3834 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
   3835 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
   3836 	}
   3837 
   3838       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
   3839       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
   3840 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
   3841 
   3842       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
   3843 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
   3844       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
   3845 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
   3846 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
   3847 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
   3848 
   3849       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
   3850 	 any module uses it.  */
   3851       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
   3852 
   3853       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3854       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3855 
   3856       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
   3857       if (new_flags != old_flags)
   3858 	{
   3859 	  error = true;
   3860 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3861 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3862 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
   3863 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
   3864 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
   3865 	}
   3866 
   3867       if (error)
   3868 	{
   3869 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3870 	  return false;
   3871 	}
   3872     }
   3873 
   3874   return true;
   3875 }
   3876 
   3877 static bfd_reloc_status_type
   3878 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
   3879 		     asection *input_section,
   3880 		     unsigned long offset,
   3881 		     bfd_byte *loc,
   3882 		     bfd_vma value,
   3883 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
   3884 		     bool fixup)
   3885 {
   3886   unsigned int insn, opcode;
   3887 
   3888   if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   3889     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   3890   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
   3891   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
   3892   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
   3893       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
   3894       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
   3895       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
   3896       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
   3897     {
   3898       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
   3899 	{
   3900 	  if (fixup)
   3901 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
   3902 	  else
   3903 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3904 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3905 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3906 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3907 	}
   3908     }
   3909   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
   3910 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
   3911 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
   3912 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
   3913 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
   3914 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
   3915 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
   3916     {
   3917       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
   3918 	{
   3919 	  if (fixup)
   3920 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
   3921 	  else
   3922 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3923 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3924 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3925 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3926 	}
   3927     }
   3928   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
   3929     {
   3930       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
   3931       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3932       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
   3933 	{
   3934 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
   3935 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
   3936 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3937 	}
   3938     }
   3939   else
   3940     {
   3941       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
   3942       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
   3943     }
   3944   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3945   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
   3946   return bfd_reloc_ok;
   3947 }
   3948 
   3949 static void
   3950 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
   3951 {
   3952   unsigned int insn;
   3953 
   3954   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   3955   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   3956   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   3957   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3958   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   3959   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3960   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   3961   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3962   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
   3963 }
   3964 
   3965 
   3966 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
   3968    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
   3969 int
   3970 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   3971 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3972 {
   3973   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   3974   flagword flags;
   3975 
   3976   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   3977 
   3978   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3979     {
   3980       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3981 
   3982       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
   3983 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3984       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3985 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   3986 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
   3987 					     false, false, true)) != NULL
   3988 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
   3989 		   || h->needs_plt)
   3990 	       && h->ref_regular
   3991 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   3992 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   3993 	{
   3994 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
   3995 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
   3996 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
   3997 	     r30 to be set up.  */
   3998 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3999 	}
   4000       else
   4001 	{
   4002 	  bfd *ibfd;
   4003 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
   4004 
   4005 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
   4006 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
   4007 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
   4008 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
   4009 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   4010 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4011 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4012 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4013 	      {
   4014 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
   4015 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
   4016 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
   4017 		  {
   4018 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4019 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
   4020 		    break;
   4021 		  }
   4022 	      }
   4023 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
   4024 	}
   4025     }
   4026   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   4027     {
   4028       if (!info->user_warn_rwx_segments)
   4029 	info->no_warn_rwx_segments = 1;
   4030       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW
   4031 	  || (htab->params->plt_style != PLT_OLD
   4032 	      && !info->no_warn_rwx_segments))
   4033 	{
   4034 	  if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
   4035 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
   4036 	  else
   4037 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
   4038 	}
   4039     }
   4040 
   4041   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
   4042 
   4043   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   4044     {
   4045       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   4046 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   4047 
   4048       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
   4049       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4050 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
   4051 	return -1;
   4052 
   4053       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
   4054       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   4055 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   4056 	return -1;
   4057     }
   4058   else
   4059     {
   4060       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
   4061       if (htab->glink != NULL
   4062 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
   4063 	return -1;
   4064     }
   4065   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
   4066 }
   4067 
   4068 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
   4070    relocation.  */
   4071 
   4072 static asection *
   4073 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
   4074 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4075 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4076 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4077 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   4078 {
   4079   if (h != NULL)
   4080     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   4081       {
   4082       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   4083       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   4084 	return NULL;
   4085       }
   4086 
   4087   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
   4088 }
   4089 
   4090 static bool
   4091 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
   4092 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
   4093 	   asection **symsecp,
   4094 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
   4095 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
   4096 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
   4097 	   bfd *ibfd)
   4098 {
   4099   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4100 
   4101   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4102     {
   4103       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4104       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4105 
   4106       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4107       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4108 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4109 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4110 
   4111       if (hp != NULL)
   4112 	*hp = h;
   4113 
   4114       if (symp != NULL)
   4115 	*symp = NULL;
   4116 
   4117       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4118 	{
   4119 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
   4120 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4121 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   4122 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
   4123 	  *symsecp = symsec;
   4124 	}
   4125 
   4126       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4127 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4128     }
   4129   else
   4130     {
   4131       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4132       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
   4133 
   4134       if (locsyms == NULL)
   4135 	{
   4136 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   4137 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4138 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
   4139 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
   4140 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   4141 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4142 	    return false;
   4143 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
   4144 	}
   4145       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
   4146 
   4147       if (hp != NULL)
   4148 	*hp = NULL;
   4149 
   4150       if (symp != NULL)
   4151 	*symp = sym;
   4152 
   4153       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4154 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
   4155 
   4156       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4157 	{
   4158 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   4159 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4160 
   4161 	  tls_mask = NULL;
   4162 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4163 	  if (local_got != NULL)
   4164 	    {
   4165 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4166 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4167 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4168 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4169 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4170 	    }
   4171 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
   4172 	}
   4173     }
   4174   return true;
   4175 }
   4176 
   4177 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
   4179    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
   4180 
   4181 bool
   4182 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4183 {
   4184   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4185   bfd *ibfd;
   4186   asection *sec;
   4187   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
   4188 
   4189   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4190   if (htab == NULL)
   4191     return false;
   4192 
   4193   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
   4194      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
   4195      between the call and its destination.  */
   4196   limit = 0x1e00000;
   4197   low_vma = -1;
   4198   high_vma = 0;
   4199   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4200     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
   4201       {
   4202 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
   4203 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
   4204 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
   4205 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
   4206       }
   4207 
   4208   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
   4209      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
   4210      is local.  */
   4211   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
   4212     {
   4213       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
   4214       return true;
   4215     }
   4216 
   4217   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
   4218      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
   4219      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
   4220      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
   4221      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
   4222      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
   4223      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
   4224      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
   4225      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
   4226      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
   4227      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
   4228      together except their symbol.  */
   4229 
   4230   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4231     {
   4232       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   4233       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   4234 
   4235       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4236 	continue;
   4237 
   4238       local_syms = NULL;
   4239       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4240 
   4241       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4242 	if (sec->has_pltcall
   4243 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4244 	  {
   4245 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4246 
   4247 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
   4248 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4249 						  info->keep_memory);
   4250 	    if (relstart == NULL)
   4251 	      return false;
   4252 
   4253 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4254 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4255 	      {
   4256 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4257 		unsigned long r_symndx;
   4258 		asection *sym_sec;
   4259 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4260 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4261 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
   4262 
   4263 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4264 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
   4265 		  continue;
   4266 
   4267 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4268 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
   4269 				r_symndx, ibfd))
   4270 		  {
   4271 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4272 		      free (relstart);
   4273 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4274 		      free (local_syms);
   4275 		    return false;
   4276 		  }
   4277 
   4278 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   4279 		  {
   4280 		    bfd_vma from, to;
   4281 		    if (h != NULL)
   4282 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
   4283 		    else
   4284 		      to = sym->st_value;
   4285 		    to += (rel->r_addend
   4286 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
   4287 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
   4288 		    from = (rel->r_offset
   4289 			    + sec->output_offset
   4290 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
   4291 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
   4292 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
   4293 		  }
   4294 	      }
   4295 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4296 	      free (relstart);
   4297 	  }
   4298 
   4299       if (local_syms != NULL
   4300 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4301 	{
   4302 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   4303 	    free (local_syms);
   4304 	  else
   4305 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   4306 	}
   4307     }
   4308 
   4309   return true;
   4310 }
   4311 
   4312 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
   4313    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
   4314 
   4315 asection *
   4316 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4317 {
   4318   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4319 
   4320   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4321   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   4322 					     false, false, true);
   4323   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   4324     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
   4325 
   4326   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   4327     {
   4328       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
   4329       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
   4330 				  false, false, true);
   4331       if (opt != NULL
   4332 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4333 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   4334 	{
   4335 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
   4336 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
   4337 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
   4338 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   4339 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
   4340 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   4341 	      && tga != NULL
   4342 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
   4343 		  || tga->needs_plt)
   4344 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
   4345 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
   4346 	    {
   4347 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4348 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4349 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4350 		  break;
   4351 	      if (ent != NULL)
   4352 		{
   4353 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
   4354 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
   4355 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
   4356 		  opt->mark = 1;
   4357 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
   4358 		    {
   4359 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
   4360 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
   4361 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   4362 					      opt->dynstr_index);
   4363 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
   4364 			return NULL;
   4365 		    }
   4366 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
   4367 		}
   4368 	    }
   4369 	}
   4370       else
   4371 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
   4372     }
   4373   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   4374       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4375       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
   4376     {
   4377       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
   4378       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
   4379     }
   4380 
   4381   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
   4382 }
   4383 
   4384 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
   4385    HASH.  */
   4386 
   4387 static bool
   4388 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
   4389 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4390 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
   4391 {
   4392   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4393   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4394   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4395 
   4396   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4397     {
   4398       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4399       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4400 
   4401       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4402       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4403 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4404 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4405       if (h == hash)
   4406 	return true;
   4407     }
   4408   return false;
   4409 }
   4410 
   4411 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
   4412    opportunities.  */
   4413 
   4414 bool
   4415 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   4416 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4417 {
   4418   bfd *ibfd;
   4419   asection *sec;
   4420   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4421   int pass;
   4422 
   4423   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   4424     return true;
   4425 
   4426   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4427   if (htab == NULL)
   4428     return false;
   4429 
   4430   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
   4431 
   4432   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
   4433      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
   4434      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
   4435      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
   4436      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
   4437      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
   4438   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
   4439     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4440       {
   4441 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4442 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
   4443 
   4444 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4445 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4446 	    {
   4447 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4448 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4449 
   4450 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
   4451 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4452 						    info->keep_memory);
   4453 	      if (relstart == NULL)
   4454 		return false;
   4455 
   4456 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4457 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4458 		{
   4459 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4460 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
   4461 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
   4462 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4463 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
   4464 		  bool is_local;
   4465 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
   4466 
   4467 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4468 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4469 		    {
   4470 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4471 
   4472 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4473 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4474 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4475 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4476 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4477 		    }
   4478 
   4479 		  is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
   4480 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4481 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4482 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
   4483 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
   4484 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
   4485 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
   4486 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
   4487 		  if (pass == 0
   4488 		      && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4489 		      && h != NULL
   4490 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   4491 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
   4492 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4493 		    {
   4494 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
   4495 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
   4496 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4497 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4498 			free (relstart);
   4499 		      return true;
   4500 		    }
   4501 
   4502 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4503 		  switch (r_type)
   4504 		    {
   4505 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   4506 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   4507 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4508 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4509 
   4510 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   4511 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   4512 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
   4513 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
   4514 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
   4515 		      if (!is_local)
   4516 			continue;
   4517 
   4518 		      /* LD -> LE */
   4519 		      tls_set = 0;
   4520 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
   4521 		      break;
   4522 
   4523 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   4524 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   4525 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4526 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4527 
   4528 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   4529 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   4530 		      if (is_local)
   4531 			/* GD -> LE */
   4532 			tls_set = 0;
   4533 		      else
   4534 			/* GD -> IE */
   4535 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
   4536 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
   4537 		      break;
   4538 
   4539 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   4540 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   4541 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   4542 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   4543 		      if (is_local)
   4544 			{
   4545 			  /* IE -> LE */
   4546 			  tls_set = 0;
   4547 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
   4548 			  break;
   4549 			}
   4550 		      else
   4551 			continue;
   4552 
   4553 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   4554 		      if (!is_local)
   4555 			continue;
   4556 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4557 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   4558 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4559 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   4560 			{
   4561 			  if (pass != 0
   4562 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
   4563 			    {
   4564 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
   4565 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
   4566 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4567 				{
   4568 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4569 
   4570 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4571 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4572 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4573 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4574 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4575 				  if (h != NULL)
   4576 				    {
   4577 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
   4578 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4579 
   4580 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4581 					addend = rel->r_addend;
   4582 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
   4583 							  got2, addend);
   4584 				      if (ent != NULL
   4585 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4586 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4587 				    }
   4588 				}
   4589 			    }
   4590 			  continue;
   4591 			}
   4592 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
   4593 		      tls_set = 0;
   4594 		      tls_clear = 0;
   4595 		      break;
   4596 
   4597 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   4598 		      if (pass == 0)
   4599 			{
   4600 			  unsigned char buf[4];
   4601 			  unsigned int insn;
   4602 			  bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
   4603 			  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
   4604 							 off, 4))
   4605 			    {
   4606 			      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4607 				free (relstart);
   4608 			      return false;
   4609 			    }
   4610 			  insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
   4611 			  /* addis rt,2,imm */
   4612 			  if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
   4613 			      != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
   4614 			    {
   4615 			      /* xgettext:c-format */
   4616 			      info->callbacks->minfo
   4617 				(_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
   4618 				 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
   4619 			      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4620 			    }
   4621 			}
   4622 		      continue;
   4623 
   4624 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   4625 		      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4626 		      continue;
   4627 
   4628 		    default:
   4629 		      continue;
   4630 		    }
   4631 
   4632 		  if (pass == 0)
   4633 		    {
   4634 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
   4635 			  || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4636 			continue;
   4637 
   4638 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4639 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
   4640 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
   4641 			continue;
   4642 
   4643 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
   4644 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
   4645 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
   4646 			 the entire optimization.  */
   4647 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
   4648 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
   4649 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4650 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4651 			free (relstart);
   4652 		      return true;
   4653 		    }
   4654 
   4655 		  if (h != NULL)
   4656 		    {
   4657 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4658 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
   4659 		    }
   4660 		  else
   4661 		    {
   4662 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
   4663 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   4664 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
   4665 
   4666 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4667 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
   4668 			abort ();
   4669 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4670 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4671 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4672 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4673 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4674 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
   4675 		    }
   4676 
   4677 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4678 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
   4679 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
   4680 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
   4681 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
   4682 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
   4683 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
   4684 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
   4685 		      && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4686 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   4687 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
   4688 		    continue;
   4689 
   4690 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4691 		    {
   4692 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4693 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4694 
   4695 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   4696 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   4697 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
   4698 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
   4699 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
   4700 					  got2, addend);
   4701 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4702 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4703 		    }
   4704 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
   4705 		    continue;
   4706 
   4707 		  if (tls_set == 0)
   4708 		    {
   4709 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
   4710 		      if (*got_count > 0)
   4711 			*got_count -= 1;
   4712 		    }
   4713 
   4714 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
   4715 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
   4716 		}
   4717 
   4718 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4719 		free (relstart);
   4720 	    }
   4721       }
   4722   return true;
   4723 }
   4724 
   4725 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
   4727    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
   4728    size_dynamic_sections.  */
   4729 
   4730 static bool
   4731 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4732 {
   4733   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
   4734   do
   4735     {
   4736       if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
   4737 	return true;
   4738       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
   4739     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
   4740 
   4741   return false;
   4742 }
   4743 
   4744 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
   4745 
   4746 static bool
   4747 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4748 {
   4749   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   4750 
   4751   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   4752     if (p->pc_count != 0)
   4753       return true;
   4754   return false;
   4755 }
   4756 
   4757 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
   4758    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
   4759    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
   4760    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
   4761    understand.  */
   4762 
   4763 static bool
   4764 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4765 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4766 {
   4767   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4768   asection *s;
   4769 
   4770 #ifdef DEBUG
   4771   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
   4772 	   h->root.root.string);
   4773 #endif
   4774 
   4775   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
   4776   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4777   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
   4778 	      && (h->needs_plt
   4779 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4780 		  || h->is_weakalias
   4781 		  || (h->def_dynamic
   4782 		      && h->ref_regular
   4783 		      && !h->def_regular)));
   4784 
   4785   /* Deal with function syms.  */
   4786   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
   4787       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4788       || h->needs_plt)
   4789     {
   4790       bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4791 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
   4792       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
   4793 	 function symbol is local.  */
   4794       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
   4795 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4796 
   4797       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
   4798 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
   4799       struct plt_entry *ent;
   4800       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4801 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4802 	  break;
   4803       if (ent == NULL
   4804 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4805 	      && local
   4806 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   4807 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   4808 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
   4809 	{
   4810 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
   4811 
   4812 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
   4813 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
   4814 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
   4815 
   4816 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
   4817 
   4818 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
   4819 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
   4820 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4821 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   4822 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4823 	}
   4824       else
   4825 	{
   4826 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
   4827 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
   4828 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
   4829 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
   4830 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
   4831 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
   4832 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
   4833 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
   4834 	     than link time.  */
   4835 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
   4836 	       || (h->non_got_ref
   4837 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
   4838 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4839 	      && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4840 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4841 	      && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4842 	    {
   4843 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4844 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
   4845 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
   4846 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   4847 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4848 	    }
   4849 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   4850 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
   4851 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
   4852 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4853 	}
   4854       h->protected_def = 0;
   4855       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
   4856       return true;
   4857     }
   4858   else
   4859     h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4860 
   4861   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
   4862      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
   4863      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
   4864   if (h->is_weakalias)
   4865     {
   4866       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
   4867       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
   4868       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
   4869       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
   4870       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
   4871 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   4872 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
   4873 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4874       return true;
   4875     }
   4876 
   4877   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
   4878      is not a function.  */
   4879 
   4880   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
   4881      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
   4882      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
   4883      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
   4884   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4885     {
   4886       h->protected_def = 0;
   4887       return true;
   4888     }
   4889 
   4890   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
   4891      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
   4892   if (!h->non_got_ref)
   4893     {
   4894       h->protected_def = 0;
   4895       return true;
   4896     }
   4897 
   4898   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
   4899      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
   4900      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
   4901      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
   4902   if (h->protected_def)
   4903     {
   4904       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4905 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   4906 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   4907 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
   4908 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
   4909 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
   4910       return true;
   4911     }
   4912 
   4913   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
   4914   if (info->nocopyreloc)
   4915     return true;
   4916 
   4917    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
   4918       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
   4919       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
   4920       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
   4921       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
   4922       executable.  */
   4923   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4924       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4925       && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4926       && !h->def_regular
   4927       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4928     return true;
   4929 
   4930   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
   4931      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
   4932      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
   4933      object will contain position independent code, so all references
   4934      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
   4935      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
   4936      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
   4937      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
   4938      same memory location for the variable.
   4939 
   4940      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
   4941      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
   4942   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4943     s = htab->dynsbss;
   4944   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4945     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
   4946   else
   4947     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
   4948   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   4949 
   4950   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
   4951     {
   4952       asection *srel;
   4953 
   4954       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
   4955 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
   4956 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
   4957       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4958 	srel = htab->relsbss;
   4959       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4960 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   4961       else
   4962 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
   4963       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
   4964       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   4965       h->needs_copy = 1;
   4966     }
   4967 
   4968   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
   4969   h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4970   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
   4971 }
   4972 
   4973 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
   4975    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
   4976    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
   4977    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
   4978    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
   4979 
   4980 static bool
   4981 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
   4982 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4983 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4984 {
   4985   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   4986   size_t len1, len2, len3;
   4987   char *name;
   4988   const char *stub;
   4989   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4990 
   4991   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4992     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
   4993   else
   4994     stub = ".plt_call32.";
   4995 
   4996   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
   4997   len2 = strlen (stub);
   4998   len3 = 0;
   4999   if (ent->sec)
   5000     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
   5001   name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
   5002   if (name == NULL)
   5003     return false;
   5004   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
   5005   if (ent->sec)
   5006     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
   5007   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
   5008   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
   5009   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
   5010   if (sh == NULL)
   5011     return false;
   5012   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5013     {
   5014       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5015       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5016       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
   5017       sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5018       sh->def_regular = 1;
   5019       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5020       sh->forced_local = 1;
   5021       sh->non_elf = 0;
   5022       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5023     }
   5024   return true;
   5025 }
   5026 
   5027 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
   5028    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
   5029 
   5030 static bfd_vma
   5031 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
   5032 {
   5033   bfd_vma where;
   5034   unsigned int max_before_header;
   5035 
   5036   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5037     {
   5038       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5039       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5040     }
   5041   else
   5042     {
   5043       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
   5044       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
   5045 	{
   5046 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
   5047 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
   5048 	}
   5049       else
   5050 	{
   5051 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
   5052 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
   5053 	    {
   5054 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5055 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
   5056 	    }
   5057 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5058 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5059 	}
   5060     }
   5061   return where;
   5062 }
   5063 
   5064 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
   5065    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
   5066 
   5067 static inline unsigned int
   5068 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
   5069 {
   5070   unsigned int need;
   5071   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
   5072     need = 4;
   5073   else
   5074     {
   5075       need = 0;
   5076       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   5077 	need += 8;
   5078       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   5079 	need += 4;
   5080       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   5081 	need += 4;
   5082     }
   5083   return need;
   5084 }
   5085 
   5086 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
   5087 
   5088 static bool
   5089 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5090 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5091 {
   5092   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
   5093 
   5094   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
   5095       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
   5096 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   5097 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   5098       && h->dynindx == -1
   5099       && !h->forced_local
   5100       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
   5101     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
   5102   return true;
   5103 }
   5104 
   5105 /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
   5106    usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry.  */
   5107 
   5108 static inline
   5109 bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5110 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5111 {
   5112   return (h == NULL
   5113 	  || h->dynindx == -1
   5114 	  || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
   5115 }
   5116 
   5117 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
   5118 
   5119 static bool
   5120 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   5121 {
   5122   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
   5123   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   5124   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5125   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   5126 
   5127   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   5128     return true;
   5129 
   5130   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5131   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   5132   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
   5133       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   5134 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
   5135 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
   5136 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5137 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5138 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5139     {
   5140       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5141       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
   5142 	return false;
   5143 
   5144       unsigned int need = got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
   5145       unsigned int rel_need = need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5146       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5147 	{
   5148 	  if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
   5149 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
   5150 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
   5151 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
   5152 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5153 	  else
   5154 	    {
   5155 	      need += 8;
   5156 	      rel_need += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5157 	    }
   5158 	}
   5159       if (need == 0)
   5160 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5161       else
   5162 	{
   5163 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5164 	  if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
   5165 		&& !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5166 		     && bfd_link_executable (info)
   5167 		     && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
   5168 		&& !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
   5169 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5170 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
   5171 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
   5172 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
   5173 	    {
   5174 	      asection *rsec;
   5175 
   5176 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5177 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5178 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5179 	      rsec->size += rel_need;
   5180 	    }
   5181 	}
   5182     }
   5183   else
   5184     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5185 
   5186   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
   5187      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
   5188   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5189       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5190     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5191 
   5192   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
   5193   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5194 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
   5195     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5196 
   5197   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
   5198      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
   5199   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   5200     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5201 
   5202   if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
   5203     ;
   5204 
   5205   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
   5206      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
   5207      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
   5208      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
   5209      changes.  */
   5210   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5211     {
   5212       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
   5213 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
   5214 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
   5215 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
   5216 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
   5217 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
   5218       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
   5219 	{
   5220 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5221 
   5222 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5223 	    {
   5224 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
   5225 	      p->pc_count = 0;
   5226 	      if (p->count == 0)
   5227 		*pp = p->next;
   5228 	      else
   5229 		pp = &p->next;
   5230 	    }
   5231 	}
   5232 
   5233       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5234 	{
   5235 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5236 
   5237 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5238 	    {
   5239 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5240 		*pp = p->next;
   5241 	      else
   5242 		pp = &p->next;
   5243 	    }
   5244 	}
   5245 
   5246       if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   5247 	{
   5248 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5249 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5250 	    return false;
   5251 	}
   5252     }
   5253   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
   5254     {
   5255       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
   5256 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
   5257 	 dynamic.  */
   5258       if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
   5259 	   || (h->ref_regular
   5260 	       && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   5261 	       && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
   5262 		   || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
   5263 	  && !h->def_regular
   5264 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
   5265 	  && !(h->protected_def
   5266 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5267 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5268 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5269 	{
   5270 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5271 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5272 	    return false;
   5273 
   5274 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
   5275 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5276 	}
   5277       else
   5278 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5279     }
   5280 
   5281   /* Allocate space.  */
   5282   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   5283     if (!discarded_section (p->sec))
   5284       {
   5285 	asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5286 	if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5287 	  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5288 	sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5289       }
   5290 
   5291   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
   5292      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
   5293      a) is dynamic, or
   5294      b) is an ifunc, or
   5295      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
   5296      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
   5297   if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
   5298       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   5299       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
   5300       || (h->needs_plt
   5301 	  && h->def_regular
   5302 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5303 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5304 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   5305 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
   5306     {
   5307       struct plt_entry *ent;
   5308       bool doneone = false;
   5309       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5310 
   5311       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5312 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5313 	  {
   5314 	    asection *s;
   5315 	    bool dyn;
   5316 
   5317 	    if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5318 	      return false;
   5319 
   5320 	    dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
   5321 	    s = htab->elf.splt;
   5322 	    if (!dyn)
   5323 	      {
   5324 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5325 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5326 		else
   5327 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5328 	      }
   5329 
   5330 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   5331 	      {
   5332 		if (!doneone)
   5333 		  {
   5334 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5335 		    s->size += 4;
   5336 		  }
   5337 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5338 
   5339 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
   5340 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5341 		else
   5342 		  {
   5343 		    s = htab->glink;
   5344 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
   5345 		      {
   5346 			glink_offset = s->size;
   5347 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   5348 		      }
   5349 		    if (!doneone
   5350 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
   5351 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5352 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5353 		      {
   5354 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5355 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
   5356 		      }
   5357 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5358 
   5359 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
   5360 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
   5361 		      return false;
   5362 		  }
   5363 	      }
   5364 	    else
   5365 	      {
   5366 		if (!doneone)
   5367 		  {
   5368 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
   5369 		       for the special first entry.  */
   5370 		    if (s->size == 0)
   5371 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
   5372 
   5373 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
   5374 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
   5375 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
   5376 		       word available at the end.  */
   5377 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
   5378 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
   5379 				     * ((s->size
   5380 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5381 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
   5382 
   5383 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
   5384 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
   5385 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
   5386 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
   5387 		       relocations, and is required to make
   5388 		       function pointers compare as equal between
   5389 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
   5390 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
   5391 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5392 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5393 		      {
   5394 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5395 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
   5396 		      }
   5397 
   5398 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
   5399 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5400 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
   5401 		       is allocated.  */
   5402 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   5403 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5404 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
   5405 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
   5406 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5407 		  }
   5408 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5409 	      }
   5410 
   5411 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   5412 	    if (!doneone)
   5413 	      {
   5414 		if (!dyn)
   5415 		  {
   5416 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5417 		      {
   5418 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5419 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5420 		      }
   5421 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5422 		      {
   5423 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5424 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5425 		      }
   5426 		  }
   5427 		else
   5428 		  {
   5429 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5430 
   5431 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5432 		      {
   5433 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
   5434 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   5435 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5436 			  {
   5437 			    if (ent->plt.offset
   5438 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5439 			      {
   5440 				htab->srelplt2->size
   5441 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5442 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
   5443 			      }
   5444 
   5445 			    htab->srelplt2->size
   5446 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5447 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
   5448 			  }
   5449 
   5450 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
   5451 			   .got.plt.  */
   5452 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
   5453 		      }
   5454 		  }
   5455 		doneone = true;
   5456 	      }
   5457 	  }
   5458 	else
   5459 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5460 
   5461       if (!doneone)
   5462 	{
   5463 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5464 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   5465 	}
   5466     }
   5467   else
   5468     {
   5469       h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5470       h->needs_plt = 0;
   5471     }
   5472 
   5473   return true;
   5474 }
   5475 
   5476 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
   5477 {
   5478   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
   5479   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
   5480   1,					/* CIE version.  */
   5481   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
   5482   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
   5483   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
   5484   65,					/* RA reg.  */
   5485   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
   5486   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
   5487   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
   5488 };
   5489 
   5490 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
   5491 
   5492 static bool
   5493 ppc_elf_late_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   5494 			    struct bfd_link_info *info)
   5495 {
   5496   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5497   asection *s;
   5498   bool relocs;
   5499   bfd *ibfd;
   5500 
   5501 #ifdef DEBUG
   5502   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_late_size_sections called\n");
   5503 #endif
   5504 
   5505   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5506   if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   5507     return true;
   5508 
   5509   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
   5510     {
   5511       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
   5512       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
   5513 	{
   5514 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
   5515 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   5516 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5517 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5518 	}
   5519     }
   5520 
   5521   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5522     htab->got_header_size = 16;
   5523   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   5524     htab->got_header_size = 12;
   5525 
   5526   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
   5527      relocs.  */
   5528   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   5529     {
   5530       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   5531       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
   5532       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   5533       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
   5534       char *lgot_masks;
   5535       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   5536       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   5537       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   5538       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   5539 
   5540       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   5541 	continue;
   5542 
   5543       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5544 	{
   5545 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   5546 
   5547 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
   5548 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
   5549 	       p != NULL;
   5550 	       p = p->next)
   5551 	    {
   5552 	      if (discarded_section (p->sec))
   5553 		{
   5554 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
   5555 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
   5556 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
   5557 		     the relocs too.  */
   5558 		}
   5559 	      else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   5560 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
   5561 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5562 		{
   5563 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
   5564 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
   5565 		}
   5566 	      else if (p->count != 0)
   5567 		{
   5568 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5569 		  if (p->ifunc)
   5570 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5571 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5572 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
   5573 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5574 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5575 		    {
   5576 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
   5577 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
   5578 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
   5579 		    }
   5580 		}
   5581 	    }
   5582 	}
   5583 
   5584       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   5585       if (!local_got)
   5586 	continue;
   5587 
   5588       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   5589       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   5590       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   5591       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   5592       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   5593       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5594       local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   5595       if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
   5596 	{
   5597 	  local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
   5598 					     0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   5599 	  if (local_syms == NULL)
   5600 	    return false;
   5601 	}
   5602 
   5603       for (isym = local_syms;
   5604 	   local_got < end_local_got;
   5605 	   ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
   5606 	if (*local_got > 0)
   5607 	  {
   5608 	    unsigned int need;
   5609 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5610 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5611 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
   5612 	    if (need == 0)
   5613 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5614 	    else
   5615 	      {
   5616 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5617 		if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5618 		    && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5619 			 && bfd_link_executable (info))
   5620 		    && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
   5621 		  {
   5622 		    asection *srel;
   5623 
   5624 		    need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5625 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5626 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5627 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5628 		    srel->size += need;
   5629 		  }
   5630 	      }
   5631 	  }
   5632 	else
   5633 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5634 
   5635       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5636 	continue;
   5637 
   5638       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
   5639       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5640       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
   5641 	{
   5642 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   5643 	  bool doneone = false;
   5644 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5645 
   5646 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5647 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5648 	      {
   5649 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5650 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5651 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5652 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
   5653 		  {
   5654 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5655 		    continue;
   5656 		  }
   5657 		else
   5658 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5659 
   5660 		if (!doneone)
   5661 		  {
   5662 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5663 		    s->size += 4;
   5664 		  }
   5665 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5666 
   5667 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
   5668 		  {
   5669 		    s = htab->glink;
   5670 		    glink_offset = s->size;
   5671 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
   5672 		  }
   5673 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5674 
   5675 		if (!doneone)
   5676 		  {
   5677 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5678 		      {
   5679 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5680 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5681 		      }
   5682 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5683 		      {
   5684 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5685 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5686 		      }
   5687 		    doneone = true;
   5688 		  }
   5689 	      }
   5690 	    else
   5691 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5692 	}
   5693 
   5694       if (local_syms != NULL
   5695 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   5696 	{
   5697 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   5698 	    free (local_syms);
   5699 	  else
   5700 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   5701 	}
   5702     }
   5703 
   5704   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
   5705   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
   5706 
   5707   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
   5708     {
   5709       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
   5710       if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   5711 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5712     }
   5713   else
   5714     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5715 
   5716   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
   5717     {
   5718       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
   5719 
   5720       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
   5721 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
   5722 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
   5723 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
   5724       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
   5725 	{
   5726 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5727 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5728 	    g_o_t += 4;
   5729 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
   5730 	}
   5731 
   5732       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
   5733     }
   5734   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5735     {
   5736       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5737 
   5738       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
   5739       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   5740     }
   5741   if (info->emitrelocations)
   5742     {
   5743       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5744 
   5745       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5746 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5747       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   5748       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5749 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5750     }
   5751 
   5752   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5753       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5754       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5755     {
   5756       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
   5757       /* Space for the branch table.  */
   5758       htab->glink->size
   5759 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
   5760       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
   5761       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   5762 						 ? 63 : 15);
   5763       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5764 
   5765       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
   5766 	{
   5767 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   5768 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
   5769 				     true, false, false);
   5770 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5771 	    return false;
   5772 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5773 	    {
   5774 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5775 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5776 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
   5777 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5778 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5779 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5780 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5781 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5782 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5783 	    }
   5784 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
   5785 				     true, false, false);
   5786 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5787 	    return false;
   5788 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5789 	    {
   5790 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5791 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5792 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5793 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5794 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5795 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5796 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5797 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5798 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5799 	    }
   5800 	}
   5801     }
   5802 
   5803   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5804       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5805       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5806       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
   5807       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
   5808     {
   5809       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
   5810       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
   5811       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5812 	{
   5813 	  s->size += 4;
   5814 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
   5815 	    s->size += 4;
   5816 	}
   5817     }
   5818 
   5819   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
   5820      Allocate memory for them.  */
   5821   relocs = false;
   5822   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5823     {
   5824       bool strip_section = true;
   5825 
   5826       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   5827 	continue;
   5828 
   5829       if (s == htab->elf.splt
   5830 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
   5831 	{
   5832 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
   5833 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
   5834 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
   5835 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
   5836 	    strip_section = false;
   5837 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
   5838 	     comment below.  */
   5839 	}
   5840       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
   5841 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
   5842 	       || s == htab->glink
   5843 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
   5844 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
   5845 	       || s == htab->sbss
   5846 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
   5847 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   5848 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
   5849 	{
   5850 	  /* Strip these too.  */
   5851 	}
   5852       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
   5853 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
   5854 	{
   5855 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
   5856 	}
   5857       else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
   5858 	{
   5859 	  if (s->size != 0)
   5860 	    {
   5861 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
   5862 	      relocs = true;
   5863 
   5864 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
   5865 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
   5866 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
   5867 	    }
   5868 	}
   5869       else
   5870 	{
   5871 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
   5872 	  continue;
   5873 	}
   5874 
   5875       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
   5876 	{
   5877 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
   5878 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
   5879 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
   5880 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
   5881 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
   5882 	     sections.  The linker does that before
   5883 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
   5884 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
   5885 	     into these sections.  */
   5886 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   5887 	  continue;
   5888 	}
   5889 
   5890       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   5891 	continue;
   5892 
   5893       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
   5894       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
   5895       if (s->contents == NULL)
   5896 	return false;
   5897     }
   5898 
   5899   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5900     {
   5901       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
   5902 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
   5903 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
   5904 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
   5905 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
   5906 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
   5907   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
   5908 
   5909       if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
   5910 						    relocs))
   5911 	return false;
   5912 
   5913       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   5914 	  && htab->glink != NULL
   5915 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
   5916 	{
   5917 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
   5918 	    return false;
   5919 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
   5920 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
   5921 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
   5922 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
   5923 	    return false;
   5924 	}
   5925    }
   5926 #undef add_dynamic_entry
   5927 
   5928   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5929       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   5930     {
   5931       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5932       bfd_vma val;
   5933 
   5934       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
   5935       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
   5936       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
   5937       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5938       /* FDE length.  */
   5939       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5940       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5941       p += 4;
   5942       /* CIE pointer.  */
   5943       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5944       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5945       p += 4;
   5946       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
   5947       p += 4;
   5948       /* .glink size.  */
   5949       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
   5950       p += 4;
   5951       /* Augmentation.  */
   5952       p += 1;
   5953 
   5954       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5955 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5956 	{
   5957 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
   5958 	  if (adv < 64)
   5959 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
   5960 	  else if (adv < 256)
   5961 	    {
   5962 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
   5963 	      *p++ = adv;
   5964 	    }
   5965 	  else if (adv < 65536)
   5966 	    {
   5967 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
   5968 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5969 	      p += 2;
   5970 	    }
   5971 	  else
   5972 	    {
   5973 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
   5974 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5975 	      p += 4;
   5976 	    }
   5977 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
   5978 	  *p++ = 65;
   5979 	  p++;
   5980 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
   5981 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
   5982 	  *p++ = 65;
   5983 	}
   5984       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
   5985 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
   5986     }
   5987 
   5988   return true;
   5989 }
   5990 
   5991 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
   5992    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
   5993 
   5994 static void
   5995 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   5996 {
   5997   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
   5998 
   5999   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
   6000     {
   6001       asection *s;
   6002 
   6003       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
   6004       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6005 	{
   6006 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
   6007 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6008 	    {
   6009 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
   6010 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
   6011 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
   6012 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
   6013 	    }
   6014 	}
   6015     }
   6016 }
   6017 
   6018 void
   6019 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6020 {
   6021   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6022 
   6023   if (htab != NULL)
   6024     {
   6025       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
   6026       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
   6027     }
   6028 }
   6029 
   6030 
   6031 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
   6032 
   6033 static bool
   6034 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6035 {
   6036   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
   6037       && !h->def_regular
   6038       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
   6039 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
   6040     return false;
   6041 
   6042   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
   6043 }
   6044 
   6045 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
   6047 
   6048 /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
   6049    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
   6050 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
   6051   {
   6052     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
   6053     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
   6054     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
   6055     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
   6056     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
   6057     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
   6058     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6059     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6060   };
   6061 
   6062 static const int stub_entry[] =
   6063   {
   6064     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
   6065     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
   6066     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6067     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6068   };
   6069 
   6070 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
   6071 {
   6072   unsigned int workaround_size;
   6073   unsigned int picfixup_size;
   6074 };
   6075 
   6076 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
   6077    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
   6078    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
   6079    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
   6080 
   6081 static bool
   6082 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
   6083 		       asection *isec,
   6084 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
   6085 		       bool *again)
   6086 {
   6087   struct one_branch_fixup
   6088   {
   6089     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
   6090     asection *tsec;
   6091     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
   6092        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
   6093     bfd_vma toff;
   6094     bfd_vma trampoff;
   6095   };
   6096 
   6097   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6098   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   6099   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
   6100   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
   6101   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
   6102   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
   6103   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   6104   unsigned changes = 0;
   6105   bool workaround_change;
   6106   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   6107   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
   6108   asection *got2;
   6109   bool maybe_pasted;
   6110 
   6111   *again = false;
   6112 
   6113   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
   6114   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   6115       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
   6116       || (isec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0
   6117       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   6118       || isec->size < 4)
   6119     return true;
   6120 
   6121   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
   6122      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
   6123      anyway.  */
   6124   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6125     return true;
   6126 
   6127   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
   6128   if (htab == NULL)
   6129     return true;
   6130 
   6131   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
   6132   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   6133     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   6134   trampbase = isec->size;
   6135 
   6136   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
   6137 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
   6138   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
   6139 
   6140   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6141       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6142     {
   6143       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6144 	{
   6145 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
   6146 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
   6147 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6148 	    return false;
   6149 	}
   6150       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
   6151       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
   6152     }
   6153 
   6154   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   6155 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
   6156   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
   6157   trampoff = trampbase;
   6158   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
   6159     trampoff += 4;
   6160 
   6161   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   6162   picfixup_size = 0;
   6163   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
   6164       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6165     {
   6166       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
   6167       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
   6168 	{
   6169 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
   6170 						       link_info->keep_memory);
   6171 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
   6172 	    goto error_return;
   6173 	}
   6174 
   6175       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   6176 
   6177       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
   6178       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
   6179 	{
   6180 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
   6181 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
   6182 	  asection *tsec;
   6183 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
   6184 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
   6185 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val, reladdr;
   6186 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
   6187 	  unsigned long t0;
   6188 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   6189 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   6190 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
   6191 	  unsigned char sym_type;
   6192 
   6193 	  switch (r_type)
   6194 	    {
   6195 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6196 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6197 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6198 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   6199 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
   6200 	      break;
   6201 
   6202 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6203 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6204 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6205 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
   6206 	      break;
   6207 
   6208 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   6209 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6210 		break;
   6211 	      continue;
   6212 
   6213 	    default:
   6214 	      continue;
   6215 	    }
   6216 
   6217 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
   6218 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
   6219 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
   6220 	    goto error_return;
   6221 
   6222 	  if (isym != NULL)
   6223 	    {
   6224 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6225 		;
   6226 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
   6227 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   6228 	      else
   6229 		continue;
   6230 
   6231 	      toff = isym->st_value;
   6232 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
   6233 	    }
   6234 	  else
   6235 	    {
   6236 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6237 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
   6238 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   6239 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   6240 		{
   6241 		  unsigned long indx;
   6242 
   6243 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   6244 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
   6245 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
   6246 		}
   6247 	      else
   6248 		continue;
   6249 
   6250 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
   6251 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
   6252 		 branch stub in that case.  */
   6253 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
   6254 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6255 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
   6256 		{
   6257 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
   6258 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
   6259 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
   6260 
   6261 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
   6262 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
   6263 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
   6264 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
   6265 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   6266 		    {
   6267 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6268 
   6269 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   6270 			{
   6271 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6272 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6273 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
   6274 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6275 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
   6276 			}
   6277 		    }
   6278 		  else
   6279 		    {
   6280 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
   6281 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   6282 
   6283 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   6284 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   6285 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
   6286 
   6287 		      tls_mask
   6288 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
   6289 		    }
   6290 
   6291 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
   6292 		     optimised away.  */
   6293 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   6294 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
   6295 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
   6296 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
   6297 		    continue;
   6298 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   6299 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
   6300 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
   6301 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
   6302 		    continue;
   6303 		}
   6304 
   6305 	      sym_type = h->type;
   6306 	    }
   6307 
   6308 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   6309 	    {
   6310 	      if (h != NULL
   6311 		  && !h->def_regular
   6312 		  && h->protected_def
   6313 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   6314 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
   6315 		picfixup_size += 12;
   6316 	      continue;
   6317 	    }
   6318 
   6319 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
   6320 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
   6321 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
   6322 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
   6323 	  plist = NULL;
   6324 	  if (h != NULL)
   6325 	    {
   6326 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
   6327 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6328 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6329 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
   6330 	    }
   6331 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6332 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
   6333 	    {
   6334 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6335 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6336 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6337 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
   6338 	    }
   6339 	  if (plist != NULL)
   6340 	    {
   6341 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   6342 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   6343 
   6344 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6345 		addend = irel->r_addend;
   6346 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
   6347 	      if (ent != NULL)
   6348 		{
   6349 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   6350 		      || h == NULL
   6351 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   6352 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   6353 		    {
   6354 		      tsec = htab->glink;
   6355 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
   6356 		    }
   6357 		  else
   6358 		    {
   6359 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
   6360 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
   6361 		    }
   6362 		}
   6363 	    }
   6364 
   6365 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
   6366 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
   6367 	     branch overflow.  */
   6368 	  if (tsec == isec)
   6369 	    continue;
   6370 
   6371 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
   6372 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
   6373 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
   6374 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
   6375 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
   6376 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6377 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
   6378 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6379 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
   6380 	    continue;
   6381 
   6382 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
   6383 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
   6384 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
   6385 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
   6386 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
   6387 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   6388 	    {
   6389 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
   6390 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
   6391 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
   6392 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
   6393 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
   6394 
   6395 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
   6396 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
   6397 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
   6398 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
   6399 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
   6400 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
   6401 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
   6402 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
   6403 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
   6404 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
   6405 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
   6406 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6407 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6408 
   6409 	      toff
   6410 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
   6411 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
   6412 					      toff);
   6413 
   6414 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
   6415 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6416 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6417 	    }
   6418 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
   6419 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6420 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
   6421 
   6422 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
   6423 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6424 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
   6425 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
   6426 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
   6427 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
   6428 	    continue;
   6429 
   6430 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
   6431 	  reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
   6432 
   6433 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
   6434 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
   6435 	     fixup can be created at final link.
   6436 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
   6437 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
   6438 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6439 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
   6440 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
   6441 	    continue;
   6442 
   6443 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
   6444 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
   6445 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6446 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
   6447 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
   6448 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
   6449 	    {
   6450 	      bfd_vma symaddr;
   6451 
   6452 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
   6453 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
   6454 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
   6455 		continue;
   6456 	    }
   6457 
   6458 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
   6459 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
   6460 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
   6461 	      break;
   6462 
   6463 	  if (f == NULL)
   6464 	    {
   6465 	      size_t size;
   6466 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
   6467 
   6468 	      val = trampoff - roff;
   6469 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6470 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
   6471 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
   6472 		continue;
   6473 
   6474 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6475 		{
   6476 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
   6477 		  insn_offset = 12;
   6478 		}
   6479 	      else
   6480 		{
   6481 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   6482 		  insn_offset = 0;
   6483 		}
   6484 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
   6485 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
   6486 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
   6487 		{
   6488 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
   6489 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6490 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
   6491 		}
   6492 
   6493 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
   6494 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
   6495 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
   6496 					   stub_rtype);
   6497 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
   6498 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6499 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   6500 		irel->r_addend = 0;
   6501 
   6502 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
   6503 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
   6504 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
   6505 	      f->tsec = tsec;
   6506 	      f->toff = toff;
   6507 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
   6508 	      branch_fixups = f;
   6509 
   6510 	      trampoff += size;
   6511 	      changes++;
   6512 	    }
   6513 	  else
   6514 	    {
   6515 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
   6516 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6517 		continue;
   6518 
   6519 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
   6520 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6521 	    }
   6522 
   6523 	  link_info->callbacks->minfo
   6524 	    (_("%pB: Adjusting branch at 0x%V towards \"%s\" in section %s\n"),
   6525 	     abfd, reladdr,
   6526 	     (h && h->root.root.string? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"),
   6527 	     f->tsec->name);
   6528 
   6529 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
   6530 	  if (contents == NULL)
   6531 	    {
   6532 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
   6533 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
   6534 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
   6535 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
   6536 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
   6537 		goto error_return;
   6538 	    }
   6539 
   6540 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
   6541 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
   6542 	  switch (r_type)
   6543 	    {
   6544 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6545 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6546 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6547 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6548 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
   6549 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
   6550 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6551 	      break;
   6552 
   6553 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6554 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6555 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6556 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6557 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
   6558 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
   6559 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6560 	      break;
   6561 	    }
   6562 	}
   6563 
   6564       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6565 	{
   6566 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6567 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6568 	  free (f);
   6569 	}
   6570     }
   6571 
   6572   workaround_change = false;
   6573   newsize = trampoff;
   6574   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6575       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6576 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
   6577     {
   6578       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
   6579       unsigned int crossings;
   6580       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6581 
   6582       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
   6583       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
   6584       addr &= -pagesize;
   6585       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6586       if (crossings != 0)
   6587 	{
   6588 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
   6589 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
   6590 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
   6591 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
   6592 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
   6593 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
   6594 	    {
   6595 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
   6596 	      workaround_change = true;
   6597 	    }
   6598 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
   6599 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   6600 	}
   6601       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
   6602     }
   6603 
   6604   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6605     {
   6606       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6607       if (picfixup_size != 0)
   6608 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
   6609       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6610     }
   6611 
   6612   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
   6613     isec->size = newsize;
   6614 
   6615   if (isymbuf != NULL
   6616       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
   6617     {
   6618       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
   6619 	free (isymbuf);
   6620       else
   6621 	{
   6622 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6623 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
   6624 	}
   6625     }
   6626 
   6627   if (contents != NULL
   6628       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6629     {
   6630       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
   6631 	free (contents);
   6632       else
   6633 	{
   6634 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6635 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
   6636 	}
   6637     }
   6638 
   6639   changes += picfixup_size;
   6640   if (changes != 0)
   6641     {
   6642       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
   6643 	 information for the trampolines.  */
   6644       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   6645       Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
   6646 						  * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6647       unsigned ix;
   6648 
   6649       if (!new_relocs)
   6650 	goto error_return;
   6651       memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
   6652 	      isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6653       for (ix = changes; ix--;)
   6654 	{
   6655 	  irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
   6656 
   6657 	  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6658 	}
   6659       if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
   6660 	free (internal_relocs);
   6661       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
   6662       isec->reloc_count += changes;
   6663       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
   6664       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   6665     }
   6666   else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6667     free (internal_relocs);
   6668 
   6669   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
   6670   return true;
   6671 
   6672  error_return:
   6673   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6674     {
   6675       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6676       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6677       free (f);
   6678     }
   6679   if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
   6680     free (isymbuf);
   6681   if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6682     free (contents);
   6683   if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6684     free (internal_relocs);
   6685   return false;
   6686 }
   6687 
   6688 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
   6690    discarded sections.  */
   6691 
   6692 static unsigned int
   6693 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
   6694 {
   6695   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
   6696     return 0;
   6697 
   6698   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
   6699     return 0;
   6700 
   6701   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
   6702 }
   6703 
   6704 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
   6706 
   6707 static bfd_vma
   6708 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
   6709 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   6710 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   6711 				   bfd_vma relocation,
   6712 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   6713 {
   6714   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   6715 
   6716   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   6717 
   6718   if (h != NULL)
   6719     {
   6720       /* Handle global symbol.  */
   6721       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   6722 
   6723       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   6724       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
   6725       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
   6726     }
   6727   else
   6728     {
   6729       /* Handle local symbol.  */
   6730       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   6731 
   6732       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
   6733       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
   6734       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
   6735     }
   6736 
   6737   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
   6738 							rel->r_addend,
   6739 							lsect);
   6740   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   6741 
   6742   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
   6743      as a "written" flag.  */
   6744   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
   6745     {
   6746       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
   6747 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
   6748 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
   6749       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
   6750     }
   6751 
   6752   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
   6753 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
   6754 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
   6755 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
   6756 
   6757 #ifdef DEBUG
   6758   fprintf (stderr,
   6759 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
   6760 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
   6761 #endif
   6762 
   6763   return relocation;
   6764 }
   6765 
   6766 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
   6767 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
   6768 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
   6769 
   6770 static void
   6771 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
   6772 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
   6773 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6774 {
   6775   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6776   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
   6777   bfd_vma plt;
   6778   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   6779 
   6780   if (h != NULL
   6781       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6782       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   6783     {
   6784       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
   6785       p += 4;
   6786       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
   6787       p += 4;
   6788       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
   6789       p += 4;
   6790       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
   6791       p += 4;
   6792       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
   6793       p += 4;
   6794       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
   6795       p += 4;
   6796       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
   6797       p += 4;
   6798       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   6799       p += 4;
   6800     }
   6801 
   6802   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
   6803 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
   6804 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
   6805 
   6806   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   6807     {
   6808       bfd_vma got = 0;
   6809 
   6810       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   6811 	got = (ent->addend
   6812 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   6813 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   6814       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   6815 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   6816 
   6817       plt -= got;
   6818 
   6819       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   6820 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6821       else
   6822 	{
   6823 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6824 	  p += 4;
   6825 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6826 	}
   6827     }
   6828   else
   6829     {
   6830       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6831       p += 4;
   6832       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6833     }
   6834   p += 4;
   6835   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
   6836   p += 4;
   6837   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   6838   p += 4;
   6839   while (p < end)
   6840     {
   6841       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   6842       p += 4;
   6843     }
   6844 }
   6845 
   6846 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
   6847 
   6848 static bool
   6849 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6850 {
   6851   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   6852 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   6853 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
   6854 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
   6855 }
   6856 
   6857 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
   6858    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
   6859    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
   6860 
   6861 unsigned int
   6862 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6863 {
   6864   unsigned int rtra;
   6865 
   6866   if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
   6867     return 0;
   6868 
   6869   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6870     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
   6871   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6872     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
   6873   else
   6874     return 0;
   6875 
   6876   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
   6877     /* add -> addi.  */
   6878     insn = 14 << 26;
   6879   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
   6880 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
   6881 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
   6882 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
   6883     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
   6884     insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
   6885   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
   6886     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
   6887     insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
   6888   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
   6889     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
   6890     insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
   6891   else
   6892     return 0;
   6893   insn |= rtra;
   6894   return insn;
   6895 }
   6896 
   6897 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
   6898    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
   6899    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
   6900 
   6901 unsigned int
   6902 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6903 {
   6904   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
   6905       && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
   6906 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
   6907 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   6908 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   6909 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   6910 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   6911 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   6912 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   6913 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   6914 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   6915 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   6916 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   6917 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   6918 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   6919 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   6920 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   6921 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   6922 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   6923 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
   6924     {
   6925       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   6926     }
   6927   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
   6928 	   && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
   6929 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
   6930 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
   6931     {
   6932       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
   6933       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
   6934       if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
   6935 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
   6936     }
   6937   else
   6938     insn = 0;
   6939   return insn;
   6940 }
   6941 
   6942 static bool
   6943 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
   6944 {
   6945   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
   6946 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
   6947 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
   6948 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
   6949 }
   6950 
   6951 static bool
   6952 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
   6953 {
   6954   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
   6955 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
   6956 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
   6957 }
   6958 
   6959 static bool
   6960 swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, bfd_byte *loc, asection *s)
   6961 {
   6962   if ((size_t) (loc - s->contents) >= s->size)
   6963     return false;
   6964   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (obfd, rel, loc);
   6965   return true;
   6966 }
   6967 
   6968 static bool
   6969 count_and_swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, asection *s)
   6970 {
   6971   bfd_byte *loc = s->contents;
   6972   loc += s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   6973   return swap_reloc_out (obfd, rel, loc, s);
   6974 }
   6975 
   6976 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
   6977    to handle the relocations for a section.
   6978 
   6979    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
   6980    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
   6981    zero.
   6982 
   6983    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
   6984    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
   6985    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
   6986    necessary.
   6987 
   6988    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
   6989    address or the reloc symbol index.
   6990 
   6991    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
   6992 
   6993    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
   6994    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
   6995 
   6996    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
   6997    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
   6998 
   6999    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
   7000    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
   7001    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
   7002    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
   7003    accordingly.  */
   7004 
   7005 static int
   7006 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
   7007 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
   7008 			  bfd *input_bfd,
   7009 			  asection *input_section,
   7010 			  bfd_byte *contents,
   7011 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
   7012 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
   7013 			  asection **local_sections)
   7014 {
   7015   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   7016   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   7017   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   7018   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   7019   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
   7020   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
   7021   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
   7022   asection *got2;
   7023   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
   7024   bool ret = true;
   7025   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
   7026   bool is_vxworks_tls;
   7027   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
   7028   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   7029 
   7030 #ifdef DEBUG
   7031   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
   7032 		      "%ld relocations%s",
   7033 		      input_bfd, input_section,
   7034 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
   7035 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
   7036 #endif
   7037 
   7038   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
   7039     {
   7040       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   7041       return false;
   7042     }
   7043 
   7044   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
   7045 
   7046   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   7047   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   7048     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   7049 
   7050   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   7051   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
   7052   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
   7053   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
   7054   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
   7055      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
   7056   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
   7057 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
   7058 				".tls_vars"));
   7059   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
   7060     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
   7061   rel = wrel = relocs;
   7062   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
   7063   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
   7064     {
   7065       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   7066       bfd_vma addend;
   7067       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
   7068       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   7069       asection *sec;
   7070       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   7071       const char *sym_name;
   7072       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   7073       unsigned long r_symndx;
   7074       bfd_vma relocation;
   7075       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
   7076       bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
   7077       bool warned;
   7078       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
   7079       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
   7080       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
   7081 
   7082     again:
   7083       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   7084       sym = NULL;
   7085       sec = NULL;
   7086       h = NULL;
   7087       unresolved_reloc = false;
   7088       warned = false;
   7089       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   7090 
   7091       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7092 	{
   7093 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
   7094 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
   7095 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
   7096 
   7097 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
   7098 	}
   7099       else
   7100 	{
   7101 	  bool ignored;
   7102 
   7103 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
   7104 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
   7105 				   h, sec, relocation,
   7106 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
   7107 
   7108 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
   7109 	}
   7110 
   7111       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
   7112 	{
   7113 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
   7114 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
   7115 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
   7116 	  howto = NULL;
   7117 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7118 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7119 
   7120 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
   7121 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
   7122 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
   7123 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
   7124 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
   7125 
   7126 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
   7127 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
   7128 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
   7129 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
   7130 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   7131 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
   7132 	    wrel--;
   7133 
   7134 	  continue;
   7135 	}
   7136 
   7137       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   7138 	{
   7139 	  if (got2 != NULL
   7140 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7141 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
   7142 	    {
   7143 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   7144 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
   7145 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
   7146 	    }
   7147 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
   7148 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
   7149 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
   7150 	    goto copy_reloc;
   7151 	}
   7152 
   7153       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
   7154 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
   7155 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
   7156 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
   7157       tls_mask = 0;
   7158       tls_gd = 0;
   7159       if (h != NULL)
   7160 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
   7161       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   7162 	{
   7163 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7164 	  char *lgot_masks;
   7165 	  local_plt
   7166 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7167 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7168 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   7169 	}
   7170 
   7171       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
   7172       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
   7173 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
   7174 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
   7175 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
   7176 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
   7177 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
   7178 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
   7179 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
   7180 	abort ();
   7181       switch (r_type)
   7182 	{
   7183 	default:
   7184 	  break;
   7185 
   7186 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7187 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7188 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7189 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
   7190 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7191 	    {
   7192 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7193 
   7194 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7195 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7196 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
   7197 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
   7198 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7199 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7200 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7201 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7202 	    }
   7203 	  break;
   7204 
   7205 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7206 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7207 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
   7208 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7209 	    {
   7210 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7211 
   7212 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7213 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
   7214 	      if (insn == 0)
   7215 		abort ();
   7216 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7217 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7218 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7219 
   7220 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
   7221 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
   7222 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7223 	    }
   7224 	  break;
   7225 
   7226 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7227 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7228 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7229 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7230 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7231 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
   7232 	  break;
   7233 
   7234 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7235 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7236 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7237 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7238 	    {
   7239 	    tls_gdld_hi:
   7240 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7241 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7242 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7243 	      else
   7244 		{
   7245 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
   7246 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7247 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7248 		}
   7249 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7250 	    }
   7251 	  break;
   7252 
   7253 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7254 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7255 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7256 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7257 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7258 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
   7259 	  break;
   7260 
   7261 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7262 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7263 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7264 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7265 	    {
   7266 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
   7267 	      bfd_vma offset;
   7268 
   7269 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
   7270 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   7271 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
   7272 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
   7273 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
   7274 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
   7275 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
   7276 	      if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
   7277 		  && rel + 1 < relend
   7278 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
   7279 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
   7280 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
   7281 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
   7282 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
   7283 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
   7284 		 intervening code.  */
   7285 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7286 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7287 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7288 		{
   7289 		  /* IE */
   7290 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
   7291 		  insn1 |= 32u << 26;	/* lwz */
   7292 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
   7293 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   7294 		    {
   7295 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7296 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7297 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7298 		    }
   7299 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7300 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7301 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7302 		}
   7303 	      else
   7304 		{
   7305 		  /* LE */
   7306 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
   7307 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
   7308 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
   7309 		    {
   7310 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
   7311 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7312 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7313 			   r_symndx++)
   7314 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7315 			  break;
   7316 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7317 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7318 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7319 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7320 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7321 					  + sec->output_offset
   7322 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7323 		    }
   7324 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7325 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7326 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
   7327 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   7328 		    {
   7329 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7330 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
   7331 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   7332 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7333 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7334 		    }
   7335 		}
   7336 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
   7337 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7338 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
   7339 		{
   7340 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
   7341 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
   7342 		  goto again;
   7343 		}
   7344 	    }
   7345 	  break;
   7346 
   7347 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7348 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7349 	      && rel + 1 < relend
   7350 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7351 	    {
   7352 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7353 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
   7354 
   7355 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7356 		{
   7357 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
   7358 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7359 		  break;
   7360 		}
   7361 
   7362 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
   7363 		{
   7364 		  /* IE */
   7365 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7366 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7367 		}
   7368 	      else
   7369 		{
   7370 		  /* LE */
   7371 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7372 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7373 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7374 		}
   7375 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7376 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7377 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7378 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7379 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7380 	    }
   7381 	  break;
   7382 
   7383 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7384 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7385 	      && rel + 1 < relend
   7386 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7387 	    {
   7388 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7389 
   7390 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7391 		{
   7392 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7393 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7394 		  break;
   7395 		}
   7396 
   7397 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7398 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7399 		   r_symndx++)
   7400 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7401 		  break;
   7402 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7403 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7404 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7405 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7406 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7407 				  + sec->output_offset
   7408 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7409 
   7410 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7411 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7412 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7413 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
   7414 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7415 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7416 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7417 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7418 	      goto again;
   7419 	    }
   7420 	  break;
   7421 	}
   7422 
   7423       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
   7424       branch_bit = 0;
   7425       switch (r_type)
   7426 	{
   7427 	default:
   7428 	  break;
   7429 
   7430 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
   7431 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   7432 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   7433 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7434 	  /* Fall through.  */
   7435 
   7436 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
   7437 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   7438 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   7439 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7440 	    {
   7441 	      unsigned int insn;
   7442 
   7443 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7444 	      insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7445 	      insn |= branch_bit;
   7446 
   7447 	      from = (rel->r_offset
   7448 		      + input_section->output_offset
   7449 		      + input_section->output_section->vma);
   7450 
   7451 	      /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
   7452 	      if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
   7453 		insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7454 
   7455 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7456 	    }
   7457 	  break;
   7458 
   7459 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   7460 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7461 	    {
   7462 	      unsigned int insn;
   7463 
   7464 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7465 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7466 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
   7467 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
   7468 		{
   7469 		  if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   7470 		    {
   7471 		      /* Convert addis to lis.  */
   7472 		      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   7473 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7474 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7475 		    }
   7476 		}
   7477 	      else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   7478 		info->callbacks->einfo
   7479 		  (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
   7480 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7481 		   "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
   7482 	    }
   7483 	  break;
   7484 	}
   7485 
   7486       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   7487 	  && h != NULL
   7488 	  && !h->def_regular
   7489 	  && h->protected_def
   7490 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   7491 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   7492 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   7493 	{
   7494 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
   7495 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
   7496 	  unsigned int insn;
   7497 
   7498 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
   7499 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7500 	    {
   7501 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7502 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7503 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
   7504 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
   7505 		{
   7506 		  bfd_byte *p;
   7507 		  bfd_vma off;
   7508 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
   7509 
   7510 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
   7511 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
   7512 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
   7513 		       + picfixup_size);
   7514 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7515 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
   7516 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7517 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
   7518 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   7519 
   7520 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
   7521 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7522 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7523 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7524 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
   7525 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
   7526 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   7527 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
   7528 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7529 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   7530 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7531 
   7532 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
   7533 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7534 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
   7535 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
   7536 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
   7537 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
   7538 
   7539 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
   7540 		  picfixup_size += 12;
   7541 
   7542 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
   7543 		     output is reasonable.  */
   7544 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
   7545 		  wrel++, rel++;
   7546 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
   7547 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   7548 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
   7549 
   7550 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
   7551 		     dynamic reloc.  */
   7552 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
   7553 		}
   7554 	      else
   7555 		_bfd_error_handler
   7556 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7557 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7558 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7559 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7560 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
   7561 	    }
   7562 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
   7563 		   && offset_in_range (input_section,
   7564 				       rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7565 	    {
   7566 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7567 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7568 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
   7569 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   7570 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   7571 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   7572 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   7573 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   7574 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   7575 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   7576 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   7577 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   7578 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   7579 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   7580 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   7581 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   7582 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   7583 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   7584 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   7585 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
   7586 		{
   7587 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
   7588 		  relocation = 0;
   7589 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   7590 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
   7591 		}
   7592 	      else
   7593 		_bfd_error_handler
   7594 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7595 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7596 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7597 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7598 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
   7599 	    }
   7600 	}
   7601 
   7602       ifunc = NULL;
   7603       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   7604 	{
   7605 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   7606 
   7607 	  if (h != NULL)
   7608 	    {
   7609 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7610 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   7611 	    }
   7612 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
   7613 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7614 	    {
   7615 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7616 
   7617 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   7618 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7619 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
   7620 	    }
   7621 
   7622 	  ent = NULL;
   7623 	  if (ifunc != NULL
   7624 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   7625 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   7626 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7627 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7628 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7629 	    {
   7630 	      addend = 0;
   7631 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7632 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7633 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7634 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7635 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7636 		addend = rel->r_addend;
   7637 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
   7638 	    }
   7639 	  if (ent != NULL)
   7640 	    {
   7641 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7642 		  && ent->sec != got2
   7643 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
   7644 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7645 		      || h == NULL
   7646 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
   7647 		{
   7648 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
   7649 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
   7650 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
   7651 		     apparently are using code compiled with
   7652 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
   7653 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
   7654 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
   7655 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
   7656 		     into .got2).  */
   7657 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7658 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7659 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
   7660 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
   7661 		}
   7662 
   7663 	      unresolved_reloc = false;
   7664 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   7665 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7666 		  || h == NULL
   7667 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
   7668 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   7669 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   7670 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
   7671 	      else
   7672 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   7673 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   7674 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   7675 	    }
   7676 	}
   7677 
   7678       addend = rel->r_addend;
   7679       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
   7680       howto = NULL;
   7681       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7682 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7683 
   7684       tls_type = 0;
   7685       switch (r_type)
   7686 	{
   7687 	default:
   7688 	de_fault:
   7689 	  if (howto)
   7690 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   7691 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   7692 				input_bfd, howto->name);
   7693 	  else
   7694 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   7695 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
   7696 				input_bfd, r_type);
   7697 
   7698 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7699 	  ret = false;
   7700 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7701 
   7702 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   7703 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7704 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7705 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7706 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   7707 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   7708 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   7709 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7710 
   7711 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
   7712 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
   7713 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
   7714 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
   7715 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7716 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7717 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7718 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7719 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7720 	  goto dogot;
   7721 
   7722 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7723 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7724 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7725 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7726 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7727 	  goto dogot;
   7728 
   7729 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7730 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7731 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   7732 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   7733 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7734 	  goto dogot;
   7735 
   7736 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   7737 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   7738 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   7739 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   7740 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7741 	  goto dogot;
   7742 
   7743 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   7744 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   7745 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   7746 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   7747 	  tls_mask = 0;
   7748 	dogot:
   7749 	  {
   7750 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
   7751 	       offset table.  */
   7752 	    bfd_vma off;
   7753 	    bfd_vma *offp;
   7754 	    unsigned long indx;
   7755 
   7756 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   7757 	      abort ();
   7758 
   7759 	    indx = 0;
   7760 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
   7761 		&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7762 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
   7763 	    else if (h != NULL)
   7764 	      {
   7765 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7766 		    || h->dynindx == -1
   7767 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
   7768 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7769 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
   7770 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
   7771 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
   7772 		     because of a version file.  */
   7773 		  ;
   7774 		else
   7775 		  {
   7776 		    indx = h->dynindx;
   7777 		    unresolved_reloc = false;
   7778 		  }
   7779 		offp = &h->got.offset;
   7780 	      }
   7781 	    else
   7782 	      {
   7783 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
   7784 		  abort ();
   7785 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
   7786 	      }
   7787 
   7788 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
   7789 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
   7790 	       processed this entry.  */
   7791 	    off = *offp;
   7792 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
   7793 	      off &= ~1;
   7794 	    else
   7795 	      {
   7796 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7797 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
   7798 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
   7799 				      : 0);
   7800 
   7801 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
   7802 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
   7803 		else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
   7804 			 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7805 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7806 
   7807 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
   7808 		   Initialize them all.  */
   7809 		do
   7810 		  {
   7811 		    int tls_ty = 0;
   7812 
   7813 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
   7814 		      {
   7815 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7816 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7817 		      }
   7818 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7819 		      {
   7820 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7821 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
   7822 		      }
   7823 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7824 		      {
   7825 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7826 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
   7827 		      }
   7828 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   7829 		      {
   7830 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7831 			tls_m = 0;
   7832 		      }
   7833 
   7834 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
   7835 		    if (indx != 0
   7836 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7837 			    && (h == NULL
   7838 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7839 			    && !(tls_ty != 0
   7840 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
   7841 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7842 			    && (h != NULL
   7843 				? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
   7844 				: sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
   7845 		      {
   7846 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   7847 
   7848 			if (ifunc != NULL)
   7849 			  {
   7850 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   7851 			    if (indx == 0)
   7852 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7853 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
   7854 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7855 			  }
   7856 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7857 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7858 					   + off);
   7859 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7860 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7861 			  {
   7862 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
   7863 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7864 			      {
   7865 				BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
   7866 								      &outrel,
   7867 								      rsec));
   7868 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
   7869 				outrel.r_info
   7870 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7871 			      }
   7872 			  }
   7873 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7874 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7875 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
   7876 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
   7877 			else if (indx != 0)
   7878 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
   7879 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
   7880 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   7881 			else
   7882 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   7883 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7884 			  {
   7885 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
   7886 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
   7887 			      {
   7888 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7889 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7890 				else
   7891 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
   7892 			      }
   7893 			  }
   7894 			BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
   7895 							      &outrel, rsec));
   7896 		      }
   7897 
   7898 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
   7899 		       emitting a reloc.  */
   7900 		    else
   7901 		      {
   7902 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
   7903 
   7904 			if (tls_ty != 0)
   7905 			  {
   7906 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7907 			      value = 0;
   7908 			    else
   7909 			      {
   7910 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
   7911 				  value = 0;
   7912 				else
   7913 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7914 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
   7915 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
   7916 			      }
   7917 
   7918 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7919 			      {
   7920 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7921 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
   7922 				value = 1;
   7923 			      }
   7924 			  }
   7925 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7926 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
   7927 		      }
   7928 
   7929 		    off += 4;
   7930 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7931 		      off += 4;
   7932 		  }
   7933 		while (tls_m != 0);
   7934 
   7935 		off = *offp;
   7936 		*offp = off | 1;
   7937 	      }
   7938 
   7939 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
   7940 	      abort ();
   7941 
   7942 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
   7943 	      {
   7944 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7945 		  {
   7946 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
   7947 			&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7948 		      off += 8;
   7949 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7950 		      {
   7951 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7952 			  off += 8;
   7953 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7954 			  {
   7955 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7956 			      off += 4;
   7957 			  }
   7958 		      }
   7959 		  }
   7960 	      }
   7961 
   7962 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
   7963 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   7964 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7965 
   7966 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7967 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7968 			  + off
   7969 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
   7970 
   7971 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
   7972 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
   7973 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
   7974 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
   7975 	    if (addend != 0)
   7976 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   7977 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   7978 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
   7979 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7980 		 howto->name,
   7981 		 sym_name);
   7982 	  }
   7983 	  break;
   7984 
   7985 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
   7986 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   7987 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
   7988 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
   7989 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   7990 	    {
   7991 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
   7992 						    h->root.root.string,
   7993 						    input_bfd,
   7994 						    input_section,
   7995 						    rel->r_offset,
   7996 						    true);
   7997 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7998 	    }
   7999 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
   8000 	    {
   8001 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
   8002 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
   8003 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
   8004 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
   8005 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
   8006 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
   8007 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
   8008 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
   8009 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   8010 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
   8011 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8012 				      h->root.root.string);
   8013 	    }
   8014 	  break;
   8015 
   8016 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8017 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8018 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   8019 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8020 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8021 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8022 	  break;
   8023 
   8024 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
   8025 	     object.  */
   8026 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8027 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8028 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   8029 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8030 	  if (h != NULL
   8031 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   8032 	      && h->dynindx == -1
   8033 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   8034 	    {
   8035 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
   8036 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
   8037 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
   8038 		 defined before using them.  */
   8039 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
   8040 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8041 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
   8042 	      if (insn != 0)
   8043 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8044 	      break;
   8045 	    }
   8046 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8047 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8048 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
   8049 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
   8050 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
   8051 	  goto dodyn;
   8052 
   8053 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   8054 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8055 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8056 	  goto dodyn;
   8057 
   8058 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   8059 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8060 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8061 	  goto dodyn;
   8062 
   8063 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   8064 	  relocation = 1;
   8065 	  addend = 0;
   8066 	  goto dodyn;
   8067 
   8068 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   8069 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   8070 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   8071 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8072 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8073 	  break;
   8074 
   8075 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   8076 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8077 	    break;
   8078 	  /* fall through */
   8079 
   8080 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   8081 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8082 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8083 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   8084 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8085 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   8086 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   8087 	  goto dodyn;
   8088 
   8089 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   8090 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   8091 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   8092 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   8093 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   8094 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   8095 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   8096 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
   8097 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
   8098 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   8099 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8100 	    break;
   8101 	  /* fall through */
   8102 
   8103 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   8104 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   8105 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   8106 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   8107 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   8108 	    break;
   8109 	  /* fall through */
   8110 
   8111 	dodyn:
   8112 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   8113 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
   8114 	    break;
   8115 
   8116 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8117 	      ? ((h == NULL
   8118 		  || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   8119 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
   8120 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   8121 	      : (h != NULL
   8122 		 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
   8123 	    {
   8124 	      int skip;
   8125 	      asection *sreloc;
   8126 	      long indx = 0;
   8127 
   8128 #ifdef DEBUG
   8129 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
   8130 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   8131 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   8132 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   8133 #endif
   8134 
   8135 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
   8136 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
   8137 		 time.  */
   8138 	      skip = 0;
   8139 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
   8140 							 input_section,
   8141 							 rel->r_offset);
   8142 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
   8143 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
   8144 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
   8145 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
   8146 				  + input_section->output_offset);
   8147 
   8148 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
   8149 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
   8150 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
   8151 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
   8152 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
   8153 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
   8154 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
   8155 
   8156 	      if (skip)
   8157 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
   8158 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   8159 		{
   8160 		  indx = h->dynindx;
   8161 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
   8162 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8163 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8164 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8165 		}
   8166 	      else
   8167 		{
   8168 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
   8169 
   8170 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
   8171 		    {
   8172 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8173 			{
   8174 			  /* If we get here when building a static
   8175 			     executable, then the libc startup function
   8176 			     responsible for applying indirect function
   8177 			     relocations is going to complain about
   8178 			     the reloc type.
   8179 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
   8180 			     executable, it will be because we have
   8181 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
   8182 			     will set the text segment writable and
   8183 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
   8184 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
   8185 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
   8186 			  info->callbacks->einfo
   8187 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8188 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
   8189 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
   8190 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8191 			     howto->name,
   8192 			     sym_name);
   8193 			  ret = false;
   8194 			}
   8195 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
   8196 			;
   8197 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
   8198 			{
   8199 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8200 			  ret = false;
   8201 			}
   8202 		      else
   8203 			{
   8204 			  asection *osec;
   8205 
   8206 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
   8207 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
   8208 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
   8209 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
   8210 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
   8211 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
   8212 			  osec = sec->output_section;
   8213 			  if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   8214 			    {
   8215 			      osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
   8216 			      indx = 0;
   8217 			    }
   8218 			  else
   8219 			    {
   8220 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8221 			      if (indx == 0)
   8222 				{
   8223 				  osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
   8224 				  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8225 				}
   8226 			      BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
   8227 			    }
   8228 
   8229 			  /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
   8230 			     Don't leave the symbol value in the
   8231 			     addend for them.  */
   8232 			  if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
   8233 			    outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
   8234 			}
   8235 
   8236 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8237 		    }
   8238 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8239 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   8240 		  else
   8241 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   8242 		}
   8243 
   8244 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   8245 	      if (ifunc)
   8246 		{
   8247 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   8248 		  if (indx == 0)
   8249 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8250 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
   8251 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8252 		}
   8253 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   8254 		return false;
   8255 
   8256 	      BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   8257 						    sreloc));
   8258 
   8259 	      if (skip == -1)
   8260 		goto copy_reloc;
   8261 
   8262 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
   8263 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
   8264 	      if (!skip)
   8265 		{
   8266 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
   8267 		  addend = 0;
   8268 		  break;
   8269 		}
   8270 	    }
   8271 	  break;
   8272 
   8273 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   8274 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   8275 	  if (h != NULL)
   8276 	    {
   8277 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8278 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
   8279 
   8280 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   8281 		{
   8282 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8283 		    got2_addend = addend;
   8284 		  addend = 0;
   8285 		}
   8286 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
   8287 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8288 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8289 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   8290 			      + ent->glink_offset);
   8291 	      else
   8292 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8293 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8294 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   8295 	    }
   8296 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8297 
   8298 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   8299 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8300 	      ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
   8301 				 ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
   8302 	      : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8303 				 ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
   8304 	    {
   8305 	      const int *stub;
   8306 	      size_t size;
   8307 	      size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
   8308 	      unsigned int insn;
   8309 
   8310 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8311 		{
   8312 		  relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
   8313 				 + input_section->output_offset
   8314 				 + rel->r_offset - 4);
   8315 		  stub = shared_stub_entry;
   8316 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
   8317 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
   8318 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
   8319 		  stub += 3;
   8320 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
   8321 		}
   8322 	      else
   8323 		{
   8324 		  stub = stub_entry;
   8325 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   8326 		}
   8327 
   8328 	      relocation += addend;
   8329 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8330 		relocation = 0;
   8331 
   8332 	      /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
   8333 	      insn = *stub++;
   8334 	      insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   8335 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8336 	      insn_offset += 4;
   8337 
   8338 	      insn = *stub++;
   8339 	      insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
   8340 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8341 	      insn_offset += 4;
   8342 	      size -= 2;
   8343 
   8344 	      while (size != 0)
   8345 		{
   8346 		  insn = *stub++;
   8347 		  --size;
   8348 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8349 		  insn_offset += 4;
   8350 		}
   8351 
   8352 	      /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
   8353 		 relocs to describe this relocation.  */
   8354 	      BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
   8355 	      /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
   8356 	      wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
   8357 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   8358 	      wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8359 	      memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
   8360 	      wrel++, rel++;
   8361 	      wrel->r_offset += 4;
   8362 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   8363 	    }
   8364 	  else
   8365 	    goto de_fault;
   8366 	  continue;
   8367 
   8368 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   8369 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   8370 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
   8371 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
   8372 	    {
   8373 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8374 	      break;
   8375 	    }
   8376 	  relocation
   8377 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   8378 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8379 	  addend = 0;
   8380 	  break;
   8381 
   8382 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   8383 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   8384 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
   8385 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
   8386 	    {
   8387 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8388 	      break;
   8389 	    }
   8390 	  relocation
   8391 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   8392 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8393 	  addend = 0;
   8394 	  break;
   8395 
   8396 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
   8397 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
   8398 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
   8399 	     AIX .toc section.  */
   8400 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
   8401 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8402 	    {
   8403 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8404 	      break;
   8405 	    }
   8406 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
   8407 		      || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
   8408 
   8409 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
   8410 	  break;
   8411 
   8412 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   8413 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
   8414 	    {
   8415 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8416 
   8417 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
   8418 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8419 	      if (ent == NULL
   8420 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
   8421 		{
   8422 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
   8423 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
   8424 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
   8425 		}
   8426 	      else
   8427 		{
   8428 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
   8429 		     procedure linkage table.  */
   8430 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8431 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8432 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8433 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
   8434 				  + ent->glink_offset);
   8435 		  else
   8436 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8437 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8438 				  + ent->plt.offset);
   8439 		}
   8440 	    }
   8441 
   8442 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   8443 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
   8444 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
   8445 	  addend = 0;
   8446 	  break;
   8447 
   8448 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8449 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8450 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8451 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   8452 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8453 	  plt_list = NULL;
   8454 	  if (h != NULL)
   8455 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
   8456 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8457 	    plt_list = ifunc;
   8458 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   8459 	    {
   8460 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   8461 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   8462 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   8463 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
   8464 	    }
   8465 	  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8466 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
   8467 	    {
   8468 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8469 
   8470 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
   8471 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8472 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8473 		{
   8474 		  asection *plt;
   8475 
   8476 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8477 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
   8478 		  if (use_local_plt (info, h))
   8479 		    {
   8480 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8481 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   8482 		      else
   8483 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   8484 		    }
   8485 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
   8486 				+ plt->output_offset
   8487 				+ ent->plt.offset);
   8488 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8489 		    {
   8490 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
   8491 
   8492 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   8493 			got = (ent->addend
   8494 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   8495 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   8496 		      else
   8497 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   8498 		      relocation -= got;
   8499 		    }
   8500 		}
   8501 	    }
   8502 	  addend = 0;
   8503 	  break;
   8504 
   8505 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
   8506 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8507 	  {
   8508 	    const char *name;
   8509 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8510 
   8511 	    if (sec == NULL
   8512 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8513 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8514 	      {
   8515 		unresolved_reloc = true;
   8516 		break;
   8517 	      }
   8518 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8519 
   8520 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8521 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8522 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
   8523 	      {
   8524 		_bfd_error_handler
   8525 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8526 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8527 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8528 		   input_bfd,
   8529 		   sym_name,
   8530 		   howto->name,
   8531 		   name);
   8532 	      }
   8533 	  }
   8534 	  break;
   8535 
   8536 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
   8537 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   8538 	  {
   8539 	    const char *name;
   8540 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8541 
   8542 	    if (sec == NULL
   8543 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8544 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8545 	      {
   8546 		unresolved_reloc = true;
   8547 		break;
   8548 	      }
   8549 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8550 
   8551 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8552 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8553 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
   8554 	      {
   8555 		_bfd_error_handler
   8556 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8557 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8558 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8559 		   input_bfd,
   8560 		   sym_name,
   8561 		   howto->name,
   8562 		   name);
   8563 	      }
   8564 	  }
   8565 	  break;
   8566 
   8567 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   8568 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8569 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8570 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8571 				   split16a_type,
   8572 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8573 	  goto report_reloc;
   8574 
   8575 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   8576 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8577 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8578 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8579 				   split16d_type,
   8580 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8581 	  goto report_reloc;
   8582 
   8583 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   8584 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8585 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8586 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8587 				   split16a_type,
   8588 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8589 	  goto report_reloc;
   8590 
   8591 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   8592 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8593 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8594 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8595 				   split16d_type,
   8596 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8597 	  goto report_reloc;
   8598 
   8599 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   8600 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8601 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8602 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8603 				   split16a_type,
   8604 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8605 	  goto report_reloc;
   8606 
   8607 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   8608 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8609 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8610 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8611 				   split16d_type,
   8612 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8613 	  goto report_reloc;
   8614 
   8615 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
   8616 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   8617 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   8618 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   8619 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   8620 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8621 	    {
   8622 	      r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8623 	      goto report_reloc;
   8624 	    }
   8625 	  else
   8626 	    {
   8627 	      const char *name;
   8628 	      int reg;
   8629 	      unsigned int insn;
   8630 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8631 
   8632 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8633 		{
   8634 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8635 		  break;
   8636 		}
   8637 
   8638 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8639 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8640 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8641 		{
   8642 		  reg = 13;
   8643 		  sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8644 		}
   8645 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8646 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8647 		{
   8648 		  reg = 2;
   8649 		  sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8650 		}
   8651 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
   8652 		       || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
   8653 		{
   8654 		  reg = 0;
   8655 		}
   8656 	      else
   8657 		{
   8658 		  _bfd_error_handler
   8659 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8660 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8661 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8662 		     input_bfd,
   8663 		     sym_name,
   8664 		     howto->name,
   8665 		     name);
   8666 
   8667 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8668 		  ret = false;
   8669 		  goto copy_reloc;
   8670 		}
   8671 
   8672 	      if (sda != NULL)
   8673 		{
   8674 		  if (!is_static_defined (sda))
   8675 		    {
   8676 		      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8677 		      break;
   8678 		    }
   8679 		  addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8680 		}
   8681 
   8682 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
   8683 		break;
   8684 
   8685 	      /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
   8686 		 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
   8687 		 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset.  GNU as and
   8688 		 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
   8689 		 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset.  Cope with object file
   8690 		 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
   8691 		 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects.  */
   8692 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
   8693 		rel->r_offset &= ~1;
   8694 
   8695 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8696 	      if (reg == 0
   8697 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8698 		      || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
   8699 		{
   8700 		  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8701 		  addend = 0;
   8702 
   8703 		  /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
   8704 		  insn &= 0x1f << 21;
   8705 		  insn |= 28u << 26;
   8706 
   8707 		  /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   8708 		  /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   8709 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   8710 		  /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   8711 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
   8712 		  /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   8713 		  insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
   8714 
   8715 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8716 
   8717 		  r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   8718 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8719 		      && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
   8720 		    r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
   8721 		  goto report_reloc;
   8722 		}
   8723 	      /* Fill in register field.  */
   8724 	      insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
   8725 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8726 	    }
   8727 	  break;
   8728 
   8729 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   8730 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   8731 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   8732 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   8733 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   8734 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   8735 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8736 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8737 	  else
   8738 	    {
   8739 	      bfd_vma value;
   8740 	      const char *name;
   8741 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8742 
   8743 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8744 		{
   8745 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8746 		  break;
   8747 		}
   8748 
   8749 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8750 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8751 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8752 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8753 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8754 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8755 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8756 	      else
   8757 		{
   8758 		  _bfd_error_handler
   8759 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8760 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8761 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8762 		     input_bfd,
   8763 		     sym_name,
   8764 		     howto->name,
   8765 		     name);
   8766 
   8767 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8768 		  ret = false;
   8769 		  goto copy_reloc;
   8770 		}
   8771 
   8772 	      if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
   8773 		{
   8774 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8775 		  break;
   8776 		}
   8777 	      value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
   8778 
   8779 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
   8780 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8781 					 rel->r_offset,
   8782 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8783 					 split16a_type,
   8784 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8785 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
   8786 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8787 					 rel->r_offset,
   8788 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8789 					 split16d_type,
   8790 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8791 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
   8792 		{
   8793 		  value = value >> 16;
   8794 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8795 					   rel->r_offset,
   8796 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8797 					   split16a_type,
   8798 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8799 		}
   8800 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
   8801 		{
   8802 		  value = value >> 16;
   8803 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8804 					   rel->r_offset,
   8805 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8806 					   split16d_type,
   8807 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8808 		}
   8809 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
   8810 		{
   8811 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8812 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8813 					   rel->r_offset,
   8814 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8815 					   split16a_type,
   8816 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8817 		}
   8818 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
   8819 		{
   8820 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8821 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8822 					   rel->r_offset,
   8823 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8824 					   split16d_type,
   8825 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8826 		}
   8827 	      else
   8828 		abort ();
   8829 	    }
   8830 	  goto report_reloc;
   8831 
   8832 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   8833 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8834 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8835 	  else
   8836 	    {
   8837 	      ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
   8838 				   relocation);
   8839 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   8840 	    }
   8841 	  goto report_reloc;
   8842 
   8843 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
   8844 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8845 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8846 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   8847 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8848 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8849 	    {
   8850 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8851 	      break;
   8852 	    }
   8853 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
   8854 	  break;
   8855 
   8856 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
   8857 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   8858 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   8859 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   8860 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   8861 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8862 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
   8863 	  break;
   8864 
   8865 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   8866 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   8867 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   8868 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   8869 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   8870 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   8871 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   8872 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   8873 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   8874 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   8875 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   8876 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8877 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   8878 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8879 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   8880 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   8881 
   8882 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8883 	  ret = false;
   8884 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8885 	}
   8886 
   8887       switch (r_type)
   8888 	{
   8889 	default:
   8890 	  break;
   8891 
   8892 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8893 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
   8894 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   8895 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8896 
   8897 	    {
   8898 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8899 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8900 	    }
   8901 	  break;
   8902 
   8903 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8904 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
   8905 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   8906 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8907 	    {
   8908 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8909 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8910 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   8911 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
   8912 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8913 	    }
   8914 	  break;
   8915 	}
   8916 
   8917       switch (r_type)
   8918 	{
   8919 	default:
   8920 	  break;
   8921 
   8922 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8923 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8924 	    {
   8925 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8926 		{
   8927 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
   8928 		  unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8929 		  insn &= 1;
   8930 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
   8931 		  unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
   8932 		  r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
   8933 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8934 		}
   8935 	    }
   8936 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8937 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8938 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8939 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8940 	       howto->name);
   8941 	  break;
   8942 
   8943 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8944 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8945 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8946 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8947 	    {
   8948 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8949 		{
   8950 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8951 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8952 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8953 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   8954 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8955 		}
   8956 	    }
   8957 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8958 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8959 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8960 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8961 	       howto->name);
   8962 	  break;
   8963 	}
   8964 
   8965       /* Do any further special processing.  */
   8966       switch (r_type)
   8967 	{
   8968 	default:
   8969 	  break;
   8970 
   8971 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8972 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8973 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8974 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8975 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8976 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8977 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8978 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8979 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
   8980 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
   8981 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
   8982 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
   8983 	  if (sec == NULL)
   8984 	    break;
   8985 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8986 
   8987 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8988 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   8989 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   8990 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   8991 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   8992 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   8993 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
   8994 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
   8995 	  addend += 0x8000;
   8996 	  break;
   8997 
   8998 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8999 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   9000 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   9001 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   9002 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   9003 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   9004 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   9005 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   9006 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   9007 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   9008 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   9009 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   9010 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   9011 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   9012 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   9013 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   9014 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   9015 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   9016 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   9017 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   9018 	    {
   9019 	      /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
   9020 		 certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
   9021 		 that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
   9022 	      unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
   9023 
   9024 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   9025 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   9026 	      mask = 0;
   9027 	      if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
   9028 		mask = 3;
   9029 	      else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
   9030 		mask = 15;
   9031 	      else
   9032 		break;
   9033 	      relocation += addend;
   9034 	      addend = insn & mask;
   9035 	      lobit = mask & relocation;
   9036 	      if (lobit != 0)
   9037 		{
   9038 		  relocation ^= lobit;
   9039 		  info->callbacks->einfo
   9040 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   9041 		    (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
   9042 		     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9043 		     howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
   9044 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   9045 		  ret = false;
   9046 		}
   9047 	    }
   9048 	  break;
   9049 	}
   9050 
   9051 #ifdef DEBUG
   9052       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
   9053 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
   9054 	       howto->name,
   9055 	       (int) r_type,
   9056 	       sym_name,
   9057 	       r_symndx,
   9058 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
   9059 	       (long) addend);
   9060 #endif
   9061 
   9062       if (unresolved_reloc
   9063 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
   9064 	       && h->def_dynamic)
   9065 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
   9066 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9067 	{
   9068 	  info->callbacks->einfo
   9069 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   9070 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
   9071 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9072 	     howto->name,
   9073 	     sym_name);
   9074 	  ret = false;
   9075 	}
   9076 
   9077       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
   9078 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
   9079 	 have different reloc types.  */
   9080       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
   9081 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
   9082 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   9083 	  && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   9084 	{
   9085 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
   9086 
   9087 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
   9088 	    {
   9089 	      unsigned int insn;
   9090 
   9091 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
   9092 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
   9093 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
   9094 	      else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
   9095 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
   9096 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
   9097 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
   9098 	    }
   9099 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
   9100 	    {
   9101 	      alt_howto = *howto;
   9102 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
   9103 	      howto = &alt_howto;
   9104 	    }
   9105 	}
   9106 
   9107       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
   9108 	{
   9109 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
   9110 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   9111 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   9112 	  else
   9113 	    {
   9114 	      unsigned int insn;
   9115 
   9116 	      relocation += addend;
   9117 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
   9118 			     + input_section->output_offset
   9119 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
   9120 	      relocation >>= 16;
   9121 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9122 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
   9123 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
   9124 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9125 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   9126 	    }
   9127 	}
   9128       else
   9129 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
   9130 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
   9131 
   9132     report_reloc:
   9133       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
   9134 	{
   9135 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
   9136 	    {
   9137 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
   9138 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
   9139 	      if (!warned
   9140 		  && !(h != NULL
   9141 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   9142 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   9143 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
   9144 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
   9145 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
   9146 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   9147 	    }
   9148 	  else
   9149 	    {
   9150 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   9151 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   9152 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
   9153 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9154 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
   9155 	      ret = false;
   9156 	    }
   9157 	}
   9158     copy_reloc:
   9159       if (wrel != rel)
   9160 	*wrel = *rel;
   9161     }
   9162 
   9163   if (wrel != rel)
   9164     {
   9165       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   9166       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
   9167 
   9168       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
   9169       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9170       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
   9171 	{
   9172 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
   9173 	     one NONE reloc.
   9174 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
   9175 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   9176 	  deleted -= 1;
   9177 	  wrel++;
   9178 	}
   9179       relend = wrel;
   9180       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
   9181       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9182       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
   9183     }
   9184 
   9185 #ifdef DEBUG
   9186   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9187 #endif
   9188 
   9189   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9190       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
   9191       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   9192 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
   9193     {
   9194       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
   9195       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
   9196       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
   9197     }
   9198 
   9199   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   9200       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9201       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   9202 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
   9203 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
   9204     {
   9205       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
   9206       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   9207 
   9208       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
   9209 	{
   9210 	  bfd_byte *p;
   9211 	  unsigned int n;
   9212 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
   9213 
   9214 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
   9215 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
   9216 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
   9217 	  while (n--)
   9218 	    {
   9219 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
   9220 	      p += 4;
   9221 	    }
   9222 	}
   9223 
   9224       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
   9225 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
   9226 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
   9227 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
   9228 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
   9229 
   9230       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
   9231 		    + input_section->output_offset);
   9232       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9233 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
   9234       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
   9235 	   addr < end_addr;
   9236 	   addr += pagesize)
   9237 	{
   9238 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
   9239 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
   9240 	  bool is_data;
   9241 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
   9242 	  unsigned int insn;
   9243 
   9244 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
   9245 	     the word alone.  */
   9246 	  is_data = false;
   9247 	  lo = relocs;
   9248 	  hi = relend;
   9249 	  rel = NULL;
   9250 	  while (lo < hi)
   9251 	    {
   9252 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
   9253 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
   9254 		lo = rel + 1;
   9255 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
   9256 		hi = rel;
   9257 	      else
   9258 		{
   9259 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   9260 		    {
   9261 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   9262 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   9263 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
   9264 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   9265 		      is_data = true;
   9266 		      break;
   9267 		    default:
   9268 		      break;
   9269 		    }
   9270 		  break;
   9271 		}
   9272 	    }
   9273 	  if (is_data)
   9274 	    continue;
   9275 
   9276 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
   9277 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
   9278 	     avoid the icache failure.
   9279 
   9280 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
   9281 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
   9282 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
   9283 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
   9284 	     unconditional branches:
   9285 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
   9286 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
   9287 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
   9288 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
   9289 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
   9290 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
   9291 	     instruction is not executed.
   9292 
   9293 	     A bctr example:
   9294 	     .
   9295 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
   9296 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9297 	     .	mtctr 9
   9298 	     .	bctr
   9299 	     .	nop
   9300 	     .	nop
   9301 	     . new_page:
   9302 	     .
   9303 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
   9304 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
   9305 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
   9306 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
   9307 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
   9308 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
   9309 	     place:
   9310 	     .
   9311 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
   9312 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9313 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
   9314 	     .	bctr			 bctr
   9315 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
   9316 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
   9317 	     . new_page:		new_page:
   9318 	     .  */
   9319 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
   9320 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
   9321 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
   9322 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9323 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
   9324 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
   9325 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9326 	    continue;
   9327 
   9328 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9329 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
   9330 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
   9331 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
   9332 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
   9333 
   9334 	  if (rel != NULL
   9335 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
   9336 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
   9337 	    {
   9338 	      asection *sreloc;
   9339 
   9340 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
   9341 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
   9342 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
   9343 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
   9344 		{
   9345 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
   9346 
   9347 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
   9348 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
   9349 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
   9350 		}
   9351 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9352 
   9353 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
   9354 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
   9355 		{
   9356 		case R_PPC_REL16:
   9357 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   9358 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   9359 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   9360 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
   9361 		  break;
   9362 		default:
   9363 		  break;
   9364 		}
   9365 
   9366 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
   9367 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
   9368 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
   9369 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   9370 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
   9371 		{
   9372 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
   9373 		  bfd_vma soffset;
   9374 
   9375 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
   9376 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
   9377 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
   9378 			     + input_section->output_offset);
   9379 		  while (slo < shi)
   9380 		    {
   9381 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
   9382 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
   9383 						&outrel);
   9384 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
   9385 			slo = srel + 1;
   9386 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
   9387 			shi = srel;
   9388 		      else
   9389 			{
   9390 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
   9391 			    {
   9392 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
   9393 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
   9394 			      srel = srelend - 1;
   9395 			    }
   9396 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9397 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   9398 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
   9399 			  break;
   9400 			}
   9401 		    }
   9402 		}
   9403 	    }
   9404 	  else
   9405 	    rel = NULL;
   9406 
   9407 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
   9408 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
   9409 	    {
   9410 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
   9411 
   9412 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
   9413 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9414 		delta = 0;
   9415 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9416 		{
   9417 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   9418 
   9419 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
   9420 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
   9421 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9422 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9423 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9424 		  else
   9425 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
   9426 
   9427 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   9428 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9429 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   9430 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
   9431 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9432 		}
   9433 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   9434 		{
   9435 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9436 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
   9437 			      contents + patch_off);
   9438 		  patch_off += 4;
   9439 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9440 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9441 			      contents + patch_off);
   9442 		  patch_off += 4;
   9443 		}
   9444 	      else
   9445 		{
   9446 		  if (rel != NULL)
   9447 		    {
   9448 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
   9449 
   9450 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
   9451 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
   9452 		    }
   9453 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9454 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
   9455 			      contents + patch_off);
   9456 		  patch_off += 4;
   9457 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9458 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9459 			      contents + patch_off);
   9460 		  patch_off += 4;
   9461 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9462 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
   9463 			      contents + patch_off);
   9464 		  patch_off += 4;
   9465 		}
   9466 	    }
   9467 	  else
   9468 	    {
   9469 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
   9470 	      patch_off += 4;
   9471 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9472 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9473 			  contents + patch_off);
   9474 	      patch_off += 4;
   9475 	    }
   9476 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
   9477 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
   9478 	}
   9479     }
   9480 
   9481   return ret;
   9482 }
   9483 
   9484 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
   9486 
   9487 static bool
   9488 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   9489 {
   9490   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
   9491   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9492   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9493   bool doneone;
   9494 
   9495   doneone = false;
   9496   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9497     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9498       {
   9499 	bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
   9500 
   9501 	if (!doneone)
   9502 	  {
   9503 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9504 	    bfd_byte *loc;
   9505 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
   9506 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9507 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9508 
   9509 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   9510 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
   9511 	    else
   9512 	      {
   9513 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   9514 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
   9515 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
   9516 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   9517 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
   9518 	      }
   9519 
   9520 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
   9521 	       Set it up.  */
   9522 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
   9523 	      {
   9524 		bfd_vma got_offset;
   9525 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
   9526 
   9527 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
   9528 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
   9529 
   9530 		/* Use the right PLT. */
   9531 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
   9532 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
   9533 
   9534 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
   9535 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9536 		  {
   9537 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9538 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
   9539 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9540 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9541 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
   9542 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9543 		  }
   9544 		else
   9545 		  {
   9546 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9547 
   9548 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9549 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
   9550 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9551 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9552 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
   9553 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9554 		  }
   9555 
   9556 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
   9557 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
   9558 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
   9559 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
   9560 
   9561 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
   9562 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
   9563 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
   9564 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
   9565 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
   9566 		   prescaled offset.  */
   9567 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9568 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
   9569 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
   9570 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
   9571 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
   9572 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
   9573 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
   9574 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
   9575 		   offset.  */
   9576 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9577 			    (plt_entry[5]
   9578 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
   9579 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
   9580 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
   9581 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
   9582 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
   9583 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
   9584 
   9585 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
   9586 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
   9587 		   in this PLT entry.  */
   9588 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
   9589 					       + plt->output_offset
   9590 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
   9591 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
   9592 
   9593 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9594 		  {
   9595 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
   9596 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
   9597 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
   9598 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
   9599 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9600 
   9601 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   9602 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9603 				     + plt->output_offset
   9604 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
   9605 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9606 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   9607 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9608 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9609 						htab->srelplt2));
   9610 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9611 
   9612 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   9613 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9614 				     + plt->output_offset
   9615 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
   9616 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9617 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   9618 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9619 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9620 						htab->srelplt2));
   9621 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9622 
   9623 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
   9624 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
   9625 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9626 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9627 				     + got_offset);
   9628 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
   9629 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
   9630 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
   9631 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9632 						htab->srelplt2));
   9633 		  }
   9634 
   9635 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
   9636 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
   9637 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
   9638 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
   9639 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
   9640 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9641 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9642 				 + got_offset);
   9643 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9644 	      }
   9645 	    else
   9646 	      {
   9647 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9648 		if (!dyn)
   9649 		  {
   9650 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9651 		      {
   9652 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9653 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9654 		      }
   9655 		    else
   9656 		      {
   9657 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9658 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
   9659 		      }
   9660 		    if (h->def_regular
   9661 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   9662 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   9663 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
   9664 		  }
   9665 
   9666 		if (relplt == NULL)
   9667 		  {
   9668 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9669 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
   9670 		  }
   9671 		else
   9672 		  {
   9673 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9674 				     + plt->output_offset
   9675 				     + ent->plt.offset);
   9676 
   9677 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
   9678 		      {
   9679 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
   9680 			   linker will fill it in.  */
   9681 		      }
   9682 		    else
   9683 		      {
   9684 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
   9685 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   9686 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
   9687 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
   9688 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
   9689 		      }
   9690 		  }
   9691 	      }
   9692 
   9693 	    if (relplt != NULL)
   9694 	      {
   9695 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   9696 		if (!dyn)
   9697 		  {
   9698 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9699 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9700 		    else
   9701 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9702 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9703 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9704 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9705 		  }
   9706 		else
   9707 		  {
   9708 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
   9709 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
   9710 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9711 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
   9712 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9713 		  }
   9714 		BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
   9715 					    loc, relplt));
   9716 	      }
   9717 	    doneone = true;
   9718 	  }
   9719 
   9720 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   9721 	  {
   9722 	    unsigned char *p;
   9723 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9724 
   9725 	    if (!dyn)
   9726 	      {
   9727 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9728 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9729 		else
   9730 		  break;
   9731 	      }
   9732 
   9733 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9734 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
   9735 
   9736 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9737 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
   9738 	      break;
   9739 	  }
   9740 	else
   9741 	  break;
   9742       }
   9743   return true;
   9744 }
   9745 
   9746 /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
   9747 
   9748 bool
   9749 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9750 {
   9751   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9752   bfd *ibfd;
   9753 
   9754   if (!htab)
   9755     return true;
   9756 
   9757   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
   9758 
   9759   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   9760     {
   9761       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
   9762       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
   9763       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   9764       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   9765       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
   9766       struct plt_entry *ent;
   9767 
   9768       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   9769 	continue;
   9770 
   9771       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
   9772       if (!local_got)
   9773 	continue;
   9774 
   9775       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   9776       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   9777       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   9778       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   9779       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   9780       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
   9781 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9782 	  {
   9783 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9784 	      {
   9785 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   9786 		asection *sym_sec;
   9787 		asection *plt, *relplt;
   9788 		bfd_byte *loc;
   9789 		bfd_vma val;
   9790 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9791 		unsigned char *p;
   9792 
   9793 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
   9794 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
   9795 		  {
   9796 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9797 		      free (local_syms);
   9798 		    return false;
   9799 		  }
   9800 
   9801 		val = sym->st_value;
   9802 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   9803 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
   9804 
   9805 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9806 		  {
   9807 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9808 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9809 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9810 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9811 		  }
   9812 		else
   9813 		  {
   9814 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9815 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9816 		      {
   9817 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
   9818 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9819 		      }
   9820 		    else
   9821 		      {
   9822 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9823 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
   9824 			continue;
   9825 		      }
   9826 		  }
   9827 
   9828 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
   9829 				 + plt->output_offset
   9830 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
   9831 		rela.r_addend = val;
   9832 		BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
   9833 						      relplt));
   9834 
   9835 		p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9836 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
   9837 	      }
   9838 	  }
   9839 
   9840       if (local_syms != NULL
   9841 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9842 	{
   9843 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   9844 	    free (local_syms);
   9845 	  else
   9846 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   9847 	}
   9848     }
   9849   return true;
   9850 }
   9851 
   9852 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
   9853    dynamic sections here.  */
   9854 
   9855 static bool
   9856 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
   9857 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9858 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   9859 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   9860 {
   9861   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9862   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9863 
   9864 #ifdef DEBUG
   9865   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
   9866 	   h->root.root.string);
   9867 #endif
   9868 
   9869   if (!h->def_regular
   9870       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
   9871     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9872       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9873 	{
   9874 	  if (!h->def_regular)
   9875 	    {
   9876 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
   9877 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
   9878 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
   9879 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
   9880 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
   9881 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
   9882 		 to zero.  */
   9883 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   9884 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
   9885 		sym->st_value = 0;
   9886 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
   9887 		{
   9888 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
   9889 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
   9890 		     function pointer.  */
   9891 		  sym->st_value = 0;
   9892 		}
   9893 	    }
   9894 	  else
   9895 	    {
   9896 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
   9897 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
   9898 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
   9899 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
   9900 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
   9901 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
   9902 		 relocation.  */
   9903 	      sym->st_shndx
   9904 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   9905 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
   9906 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
   9907 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
   9908 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
   9909 	    }
   9910 	  break;
   9911 	}
   9912 
   9913   if (h->needs_copy)
   9914     {
   9915       asection *s;
   9916       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9917 
   9918       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
   9919 
   9920 #ifdef DEBUG
   9921       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
   9922 #endif
   9923 
   9924       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
   9925 
   9926       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   9927 	s = htab->relsbss;
   9928       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
   9929 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   9930       else
   9931 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
   9932       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   9933 
   9934       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
   9935       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
   9936       rela.r_addend = 0;
   9937       BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, s));
   9938     }
   9939 
   9940 #ifdef DEBUG
   9941   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9942 #endif
   9943 
   9944   return true;
   9945 }
   9946 
   9947 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
   9949 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9950 			  const asection *rel_sec,
   9951 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
   9952 {
   9953   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9954 
   9955   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
   9956     return reloc_class_ifunc;
   9957 
   9958   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
   9959     {
   9960     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   9961       return reloc_class_relative;
   9962     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   9963       return reloc_class_plt;
   9964     case R_PPC_COPY:
   9965       return reloc_class_copy;
   9966     default:
   9967       return reloc_class_normal;
   9968     }
   9969 }
   9970 
   9971 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
   9973 
   9974 static bool
   9975 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   9976 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9977 {
   9978   asection *sdyn;
   9979   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   9980   bfd_vma got;
   9981   bfd *dynobj;
   9982   bool ret = true;
   9983 
   9984 #ifdef DEBUG
   9985   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
   9986 #endif
   9987 
   9988   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9989   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
   9990   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
   9991 
   9992   got = 0;
   9993   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   9994     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9995 
   9996   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   9997     {
   9998       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
   9999 
   10000       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
   10001 
   10002       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
   10003       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
   10004       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
   10005 	{
   10006 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   10007 	  asection *s;
   10008 
   10009 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
   10010 
   10011 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   10012 	    {
   10013 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
   10014 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   10015 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
   10016 	      else
   10017 		s = htab->elf.splt;
   10018 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   10019 	      break;
   10020 
   10021 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
   10022 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
   10023 	      break;
   10024 
   10025 	    case DT_JMPREL:
   10026 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
   10027 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   10028 	      break;
   10029 
   10030 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
   10031 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
   10032 	      break;
   10033 
   10034 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
   10035 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
   10036 		info->callbacks->einfo
   10037 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   10038 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   10039 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
   10040 		info->callbacks->einfo
   10041 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   10042 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   10043 	      continue;
   10044 
   10045 	    default:
   10046 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   10047 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
   10048 		break;
   10049 	      continue;
   10050 	    }
   10051 
   10052 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
   10053 	}
   10054     }
   10055 
   10056   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   10057       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   10058     {
   10059       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
   10060 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
   10061 	{
   10062 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
   10063 
   10064 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   10065 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   10066 	    {
   10067 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
   10068 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
   10069 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
   10070 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
   10071 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10072 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
   10073 	    }
   10074 
   10075 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
   10076 	    {
   10077 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
   10078 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
   10079 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10080 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
   10081 	    }
   10082 	}
   10083       else
   10084 	{
   10085 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   10086 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
   10087 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
   10088 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
   10089 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
   10090 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   10091 	  ret = false;
   10092 	}
   10093 
   10094       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
   10095     }
   10096 
   10097   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
   10098   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   10099       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   10100       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
   10101       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   10102     {
   10103       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
   10104       /* Use the right PLT. */
   10105       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
   10106 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
   10107 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
   10108 
   10109       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   10110 	{
   10111 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   10112 
   10113 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
   10114 		      splt->contents +  0);
   10115 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
   10116 		      splt->contents +  4);
   10117 	}
   10118       else
   10119 	{
   10120 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
   10121 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
   10122 	}
   10123       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
   10124       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
   10125       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
   10126       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
   10127       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
   10128       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
   10129 
   10130       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   10131 	{
   10132 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   10133 	  bfd_byte *loc;
   10134 
   10135 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
   10136 
   10137 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   10138 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10139 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10140 			   + 2);
   10141 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10142 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10143 	  BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
   10144 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10145 
   10146 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   10147 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10148 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10149 			   + 6);
   10150 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10151 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10152 	  BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
   10153 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10154 
   10155 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
   10156 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
   10157 	     in which symbols were output.  */
   10158 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
   10159 	    {
   10160 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
   10161 
   10162 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10163 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10164 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10165 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10166 
   10167 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10168 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10169 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10170 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10171 
   10172 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10173 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
   10174 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10175 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10176 	    }
   10177 	}
   10178     }
   10179 
   10180   if (htab->glink != NULL
   10181       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
   10182       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   10183     {
   10184       unsigned char *p;
   10185       unsigned char *endp;
   10186       bfd_vma res0;
   10187 
   10188       /*
   10189        * PIC glink code is the following:
   10190        *
   10191        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10192        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
   10193        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
   10194        *   mtctr 11
   10195        *   bctr
   10196        *
   10197        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
   10198        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
   10199        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
   10200        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
   10201        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
   10202        * .
   10203        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
   10204        * res_n_m3: nop
   10205        * res_n_m2: nop
   10206        * res_n_m1:
   10207        *
   10208        * PLTresolve:
   10209        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
   10210        *    mflr 0
   10211        *    bcl 20,31,1f
   10212        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
   10213        *    mflr 12
   10214        *    mtlr 0
   10215        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
   10216        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
   10217        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10218        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10219        *    mtctr 0
   10220        *    add 0,11,11
   10221        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10222        *    bctr
   10223        *
   10224        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
   10225        *
   10226        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10227        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
   10228        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
   10229        *   mtctr 11
   10230        *   bctr
   10231        *
   10232        * The branch table is the same, then comes
   10233        *
   10234        * PLTresolve:
   10235        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
   10236        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
   10237        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10238        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
   10239        *    mtctr 0
   10240        *    add 0,11,11
   10241        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10242        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10243        *    bctr
   10244        */
   10245 
   10246       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
   10247 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
   10248       p = htab->glink->contents;
   10249       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
   10250       endp = htab->glink->contents;
   10251       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10252       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
   10253 	{
   10254 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
   10255 	  p += 4;
   10256 	}
   10257       while (p < endp)
   10258 	{
   10259 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   10260 	  p += 4;
   10261 	}
   10262 
   10263       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
   10264 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10265 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10266 
   10267       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
   10268 	{
   10269 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
   10270 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
   10271 	     glink branch table.  */
   10272 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   10273 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
   10274 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10275 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10276 
   10277 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
   10278 	       page_addr > glink_start;
   10279 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
   10280 	    {
   10281 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
   10282 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   10283 	      unsigned int insn;
   10284 
   10285 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
   10286 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   10287 	      if (insn == BCTR)
   10288 		{
   10289 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
   10290 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
   10291 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
   10292 		  if (insn == BCTR)
   10293 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10294 		  else
   10295 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10296 		}
   10297 	    }
   10298 	}
   10299 
   10300       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
   10301       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10302       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   10303 	{
   10304 	  bfd_vma bcl;
   10305 
   10306 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
   10307 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10308 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10309 
   10310 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
   10311 	  p += 4;
   10312 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
   10313 	  p += 4;
   10314 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
   10315 	  p += 4;
   10316 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
   10317 	  p += 4;
   10318 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
   10319 	  p += 4;
   10320 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
   10321 	  p += 4;
   10322 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
   10323 	  p += 4;
   10324 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10325 	  p += 4;
   10326 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
   10327 	    {
   10328 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10329 	      p += 4;
   10330 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
   10331 	      p += 4;
   10332 	    }
   10333 	  else
   10334 	    {
   10335 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10336 	      p += 4;
   10337 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10338 	      p += 4;
   10339 	    }
   10340 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10341 	  p += 4;
   10342 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10343 	}
   10344       else
   10345 	{
   10346 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
   10347 	  p += 4;
   10348 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
   10349 	  p += 4;
   10350 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10351 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10352 	  else
   10353 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10354 	  p += 4;
   10355 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
   10356 	  p += 4;
   10357 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10358 	  p += 4;
   10359 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10360 	  p += 4;
   10361 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10362 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
   10363 	  else
   10364 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10365 	}
   10366       p += 4;
   10367       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
   10368       p += 4;
   10369       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   10370       p += 4;
   10371       while (p < endp)
   10372 	{
   10373 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
   10374 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   10375 	  p += 4;
   10376 	}
   10377       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
   10378     }
   10379 
   10380   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   10381       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   10382     {
   10383       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10384       bfd_vma val;
   10385 
   10386       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   10387       /* FDE length.  */
   10388       p += 4;
   10389       /* CIE pointer.  */
   10390       p += 4;
   10391       /* Offset to .glink.  */
   10392       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10393 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10394       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
   10395 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
   10396       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10397       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   10398 
   10399       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
   10400 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
   10401 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
   10402 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
   10403 	return false;
   10404     }
   10405 
   10406   return ret;
   10407 }
   10408 
   10409 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
   10411 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
   10412 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
   10413 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
   10414 #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
   10415 #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
   10416 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
   10417 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
   10418 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
   10419 #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
   10420 
   10421 #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10422 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10423 #endif
   10424 
   10425 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
   10426 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
   10427 #endif
   10428 
   10429 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
   10430 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
   10431 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
   10432 #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
   10433 #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
   10434 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
   10435 
   10436 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
   10437 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
   10438 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
   10439 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
   10440 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
   10441 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
   10442 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
   10443 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
   10444 
   10445 #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
   10446 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
   10447 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
   10448 #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
   10449 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
   10450 #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
   10451 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
   10452 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
   10453 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
   10454 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
   10455 #define elf_backend_late_size_sections		ppc_elf_late_size_sections
   10456 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
   10457 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
   10458 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
   10459 #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
   10460 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
   10461 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
   10462 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
   10463 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
   10464 #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
   10465 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
   10466 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
   10467 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
   10468 #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
   10469 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
   10470 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
   10471 #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
   10472 #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
   10473 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
   10474 
   10475 #include "elf32-target.h"
   10476 
   10477 /* FreeBSD Target */
   10478 
   10479 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10480 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10481 
   10482 #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10483 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
   10484 #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10485 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
   10486 
   10487 #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10488 #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
   10489 
   10490 #undef  elf32_bed
   10491 #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
   10492 
   10493 #include "elf32-target.h"
   10494 
   10495 /* VxWorks Target */
   10496 
   10497 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10498 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10499 
   10500 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10501 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
   10502 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10503 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
   10504 
   10505 #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10506 
   10507 #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
   10508 #define ELF_TARGET_OS		is_vxworks
   10509 
   10510 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
   10511 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   10512 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   10513 {
   10514   if (sec->name == NULL)
   10515     return NULL;
   10516 
   10517   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
   10518     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10519 
   10520   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10521 }
   10522 
   10523 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
   10524    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
   10525 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   10526 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   10527 {
   10528   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
   10529 
   10530   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
   10531   if (ret)
   10532     {
   10533       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
   10534 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
   10535       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
   10536       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10537       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10538       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10539     }
   10540   return ret;
   10541 }
   10542 
   10543 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
   10544 static bool
   10545 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   10546 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   10547 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10548 				 const char **namep,
   10549 				 flagword *flagsp,
   10550 				 asection **secp,
   10551 				 bfd_vma *valp)
   10552 {
   10553   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
   10554 				    valp))
   10555     return false;
   10556 
   10557   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
   10558 }
   10559 
   10560 static bool
   10561 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   10562 {
   10563   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10564   return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10565 }
   10566 
   10567 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
   10568    define it.  */
   10569 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
   10570 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
   10571 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
   10572 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
   10573 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
   10574 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
   10575 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
   10576 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
   10577 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
   10578 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
   10579 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
   10580 #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
   10581 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
   10582 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
   10583 
   10584 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
   10585 
   10586 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
   10587 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
   10588   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
   10589 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
   10590 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
   10591   ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
   10592 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
   10593 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
   10594   elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
   10595 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
   10596 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
   10597   ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
   10598 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
   10599 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
   10600   ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
   10601 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
   10602 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
   10603   elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
   10604 
   10605 #undef elf32_bed
   10606 #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
   10607 
   10608 #include "elf32-target.h"
   10609